blob: 8f502132beb02d0fd7da9327bf3ce5a98c27aa6b [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
2 HAProxy
3 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau21475e32010-05-23 08:46:08 +02005 version 1.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau9eeb57b2012-03-26 06:15:29 +02007 2012/03/24
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
17 This document is formated with 80 columns per line, with even number of
18 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020050
514. Proxies
524.1. Proxy keywords matrix
534.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
54
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +0100555. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020056
576. HTTP header manipulation
58
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100597. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200607.1. Matching integers
617.2. Matching strings
627.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
637.4. Matching IPv4 addresses
647.5. Available matching criteria
657.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
667.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4
677.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
687.6. Pre-defined ACLs
697.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100707.8. Pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020071
728. Logging
738.1. Log levels
748.2. Log formats
758.2.1. Default log format
768.2.2. TCP log format
778.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100788.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200798.3. Advanced logging options
808.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
818.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
828.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
838.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
848.4. Timing events
858.5. Session state at disconnection
868.6. Non-printable characters
878.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
888.8. Capturing HTTP headers
898.9. Examples of logs
90
919. Statistics and monitoring
929.1. CSV format
939.2. Unix Socket commands
94
95
961. Quick reminder about HTTP
97----------------------------
98
99When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
100fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
101on almost anything found in the contents.
102
103However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
104formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
105correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
106
107
1081.1. The HTTP transaction model
109-------------------------------
110
111The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100112to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200113from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
114connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
115will involve a new connection :
116
117 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
118
119In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
120establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
121by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
122length.
123
124Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
125to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
126however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
127response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
128header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
129
130 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
131
132Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
133power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
134but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200135a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200136
137A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
138keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
139second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
140page :
141
142 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
143
144This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
145latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
146correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
147the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100148server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200149
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200150By default HAProxy operates in a tunnel-like mode with regards to persistent
151connections: for each connection it processes the first request and forwards
152everything else (including additional requests) to selected server. Once
153established, the connection is persisted both on the client and server
154sides. Use "option http-server-close" to preserve client persistent connections
155while handling every incoming request individually, dispatching them one after
156another to servers, in HTTP close mode. Use "option httpclose" to switch both
157sides to HTTP close mode. "option forceclose" and "option
158http-pretend-keepalive" help working around servers misbehaving in HTTP close
159mode.
160
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200161
1621.2. HTTP request
163-----------------
164
165First, let's consider this HTTP request :
166
167 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100168 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
170 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
171 3 User-agent: my small browser
172 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
173 5 Accept: image/png
174
175
1761.2.1. The Request line
177-----------------------
178
179Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
180
181 - a METHOD : GET
182 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
183 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
184
185All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
186which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
187followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
188is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
189desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
190the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
191
192The URI itself can have several forms :
193
194 - A "relative URI" :
195
196 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
197
198 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
199 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
200
201 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
202
203 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
204
205 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
206 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
207 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
208 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
209 must accept this form too.
210
211 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
212 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
213 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100214
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200215 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
216 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
217 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
218 other protocols too.
219
220In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
221mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
222on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
223It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
224specific to the language, framework or application in use.
225
226
2271.2.2. The request headers
228--------------------------
229
230The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
231beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
232an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
233Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
234values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
235encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
236the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
237define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
238
239Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
240their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
241"Connection:" header).
242
243The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
244that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
245is one valid form of empty line.
246
247Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
248headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
249about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
250application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
251
252Important note:
253 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
254 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
255 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
256 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
257
258
2591.3. HTTP response
260------------------
261
262An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
263messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
264
265 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100266 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200267 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
268 2 Content-length: 350
269 3 Content-Type: text/html
270
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200271As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
272codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
273response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100274continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
275the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
276following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
277sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
278(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
279correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
280such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
281state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
282over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
283if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
284information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200285
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200286
2871.3.1. The Response line
288------------------------
289
290Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
291
292 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
293 - a status code : 200
294 - a reason : OK
295
296The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200297 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200298 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
299 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
300 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
301 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
302
303Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100304"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200305found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
306messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
307or "Authentication Required".
308
309Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
310
311 Code When / reason
312 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
313 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
314 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
315 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
316 400 for an invalid or too large request
317 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
318 accessing the stats page)
319 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
320 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
321 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
322 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
323 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
324 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
325 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
326 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
327 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
328
329The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3304.2).
331
332
3331.3.2. The response headers
334---------------------------
335
336Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
337the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
338details.
339
340
3412. Configuring HAProxy
342----------------------
343
3442.1. Configuration file format
345------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200346
347HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
348
349 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
350 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
351 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
352 "frontend" and "backend".
353
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100354The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
355referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
356delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100357preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100358escaped by doubling them.
359
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200360
3612.2. Time format
362----------------
363
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100364Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100365values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
366otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
367numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
368for every keyword. Supported units are :
369
370 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
371 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
372 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
373 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
374 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
375 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
376
377
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003782.3. Examples
379-------------
380
381 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
382 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
383 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
384 global
385 daemon
386 maxconn 256
387
388 defaults
389 mode http
390 timeout connect 5000ms
391 timeout client 50000ms
392 timeout server 50000ms
393
394 frontend http-in
395 bind *:80
396 default_backend servers
397
398 backend servers
399 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
400
401
402 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
403 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
404 global
405 daemon
406 maxconn 256
407
408 defaults
409 mode http
410 timeout connect 5000ms
411 timeout client 50000ms
412 timeout server 50000ms
413
414 listen http-in
415 bind *:80
416 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
417
418
419Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
420
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100421 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200422
423
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004243. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200425--------------------
426
427Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
428are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
429of them have command-line equivalents.
430
431The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
432
433 * Process management and security
434 - chroot
435 - daemon
436 - gid
437 - group
438 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100439 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200440 - nbproc
441 - pidfile
442 - uid
443 - ulimit-n
444 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200445 - stats
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200446 - node
447 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100448 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100449
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200450 * Performance tuning
451 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200452 - maxconnrate
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100453 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200454 - noepoll
455 - nokqueue
456 - nopoll
457 - nosepoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100458 - nosplice
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200459 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200460 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200461 - tune.chksize
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200462 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100463 - tune.maxaccept
464 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200465 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200466 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100467 - tune.rcvbuf.client
468 - tune.rcvbuf.server
469 - tune.sndbuf.client
470 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100471
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200472 * Debugging
473 - debug
474 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200475
476
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004773.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200478------------------------------------
479
480chroot <jail dir>
481 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
482 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
483 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
484 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
485 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
486 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100487
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200488daemon
489 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
490 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
491 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
492
493gid <number>
494 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
495 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
496 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
497 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100498
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200499group <group name>
500 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
501 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100502
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200503log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200504 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
505 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100506 configured with "log global".
507
508 <address> can be one of:
509
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100510 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100511 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
512 port).
513
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100514 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
515 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
516 port).
517
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100518 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
519 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
520 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
521 writeable).
522
523 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200524
525 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
526 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
527 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
528
529 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200530 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
531 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
532 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
533 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
534 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
535 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200536
537 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
538
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100539log-send-hostname [<string>]
540 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
541 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
542 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
543 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
544 the logs.
545
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000546log-tag <string>
547 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
548 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
549 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
550 running on the same host.
551
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200552nbproc <number>
553 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
554 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
555 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
556 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
557 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
558
559pidfile <pidfile>
560 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
561 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
562 starting the process. See also "daemon".
563
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200564stats socket <path> [{uid | user} <uid>] [{gid | group} <gid>] [mode <mode>]
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200565 [level <level>]
566
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200567 Creates a UNIX socket in stream mode at location <path>. Any previously
568 existing socket will be backed up then replaced. Connections to this socket
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100569 will return various statistics outputs and even allow some commands to be
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200570 issued. Please consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
571
572 An optional "level" parameter can be specified to restrict the nature of
573 the commands that can be issued on the socket :
574 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
575 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
576 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
577
578 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +0200579 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200580 counters).
581
582 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
583 all counters).
Willy Tarreaua8efd362008-01-03 10:19:15 +0100584
585 On platforms which support it, it is possible to restrict access to this
586 socket by specifying numerical IDs after "uid" and "gid", or valid user and
587 group names after the "user" and "group" keywords. It is also possible to
588 restrict permissions on the socket by passing an octal value after the "mode"
589 keyword (same syntax as chmod). Depending on the platform, the permissions on
590 the socket will be inherited from the directory which hosts it, or from the
591 user the process is started with.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200592
593stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
594 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
595 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100596 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200597
598stats maxconn <connections>
599 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
600 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
601
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200602uid <number>
603 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
604 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
605 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
606 one. See also "gid" and "user".
607
608ulimit-n <number>
609 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
610 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
611 option.
612
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100613unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
614 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
615
616 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
617 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
618 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
619 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
620 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
621 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
622 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
623 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
624 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
625 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
626
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200627user <user name>
628 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
629 See also "uid" and "group".
630
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200631node <name>
632 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
633
634 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
635 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
636 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
637 traffic.
638
639description <text>
640 Add a text that describes the instance.
641
642 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
643 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
644 "<" and ">" characters.
645
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200646
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006473.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200648-----------------------
649
650maxconn <number>
651 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
652 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
653 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
654 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n".
655
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200656maxconnrate <number>
657 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
658 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
659 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
660 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
661 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
662 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
663 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
664 fairness.
665
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100666maxpipes <number>
667 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
668 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
669 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
670 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
671 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
672 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
673
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200674noepoll
675 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
676 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
677 used will generally be "poll". See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll".
678
679nokqueue
680 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
681 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
682 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
683
684nopoll
685 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
686 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100687 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200688 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll" and
689 "nokqueue".
690
691nosepoll
692 Disables the use of the "speculative epoll" event polling system on Linux. It
693 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-ds". The next polling system
694 used will generally be "epoll". See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll".
695
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100696nosplice
697 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
698 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
699 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100700 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100701 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
702 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
703 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
704 "option splice-response".
705
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200706spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
707 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending health checks to servers at exact
708 intervals, for instance when many logical servers are located on the same
709 physical server. With the help of this parameter, it becomes possible to add
710 some randomness in the check interval between 0 and +/- 50%. A value between
711 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The default value remains at 0.
712
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200713tune.bufsize <number>
714 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
715 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
716 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
717 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
718 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
719 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
720 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
721 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
722
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200723tune.chksize <number>
724 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
725 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
726 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
727 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
728 checks whenever possible.
729
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200730tune.http.maxhdr <number>
731 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
732 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
733 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
734 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
735 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
736 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
737 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
738 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
739 limit too high.
740
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100741tune.maxaccept <number>
742 Sets the maximum number of consecutive accepts that a process may perform on
743 a single wake up. High values give higher priority to high connection rates,
744 while lower values give higher priority to already established connections.
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100745 This value is limited to 100 by default in single process mode. However, in
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100746 multi-process mode (nbproc > 1), it defaults to 8 so that when one process
747 wakes up, it does not take all incoming connections for itself and leaves a
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100748 part of them to other processes. Setting this value to -1 completely disables
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100749 the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
750
751tune.maxpollevents <number>
752 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
753 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
754 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
755 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
756 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
757
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200758tune.maxrewrite <number>
759 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
760 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
761 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
762 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
763 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
764 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
765 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
766 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
767 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
768 bufsize.
769
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200770tune.pipesize <number>
771 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
772 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
773 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
774 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
775 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
776 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
777
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100778tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
779tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
780 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
781 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
782 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
783 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
784 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
785 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
786 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
787
788tune.sndbuf.client <number>
789tune.sndbuf.server <number>
790 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
791 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
792 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
793 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
794 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
795 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
796 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
797 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
798 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
799 notifying haproxy again.
800
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200801
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008023.3. Debugging
803--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200804
805debug
806 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
807 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
808 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
809 system startup.
810
811quiet
812 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
813 line argument "-q".
814
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200815
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01008163.4. Userlists
817--------------
818It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
819http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
820it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
821
822userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100823 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100824 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
825
826group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100827 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100828 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
829 proceeded by "users" keyword.
830
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100831user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
832 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100833 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
834 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100835 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
836 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100837 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
838 DES-based method of crypting passwords.
839
840
841 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100842 userlist L1
843 group G1 users tiger,scott
844 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100845
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100846 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
847 user scott insecure-password elgato
848 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100849
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100850 userlist L2
851 group G1
852 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100853
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100854 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
855 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
856 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100857
858 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200859
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200860
8613.5. Peers
862--------------
863It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
864haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
865pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
866identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
867or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
868Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
869known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
870the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
871process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
872during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
873tables.
874
875peers <peersect>
876 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independant section,
877 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
878
879peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
880 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
881 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
882 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
883 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
884 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
885 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
886
887 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
888 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
889
890 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
891 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
892 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
893 across all peers.
894
895Example:
896 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +0100897 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
898 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
899 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200900
901 backend mybackend
902 mode tcp
903 balance roundrobin
904 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
905 stick on src
906
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +0100907 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
908 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200909
910
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009114. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200912----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100913
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200914Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
915 - defaults <name>
916 - frontend <name>
917 - backend <name>
918 - listen <name>
919
920A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
921its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
922section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100923section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200924
925A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
926connections.
927
928A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
929to forward incoming connections.
930
931A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
932parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
933
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100934All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
935'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
936case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
937
938Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
939logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
940proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
941However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
942name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
943
944Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
945and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100946bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100947protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
948modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
949arbitrary criteria.
950
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100951
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009524.1. Proxy keywords matrix
953--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100954
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200955The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
956limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
957they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
958limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100959marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200960option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +0200961and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
962with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
963specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100964
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200965
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100966 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
967------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
968acl - X X X
969appsession - - X X
970backlog X X X -
971balance X - X X
972bind - X X -
973bind-process X X X X
974block - X X X
975capture cookie - X X -
976capture request header - X X -
977capture response header - X X -
978clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
979contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
980cookie X - X X
981default-server X - X X
982default_backend X X X -
983description - X X X
984disabled X X X X
985dispatch - - X X
986enabled X X X X
987errorfile X X X X
988errorloc X X X X
989errorloc302 X X X X
990-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
991errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +0200992force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100993fullconn X - X X
994grace X X X X
995hash-type X - X X
996http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +0100997http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +0200998http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100999http-request - X X X
1000id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001001ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001002log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001003maxconn X X X -
1004mode X X X X
1005monitor fail - X X -
1006monitor-net X X X -
1007monitor-uri X X X -
1008option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1009option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1010option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1011option allbackups (*) X - X X
1012option checkcache (*) X - X X
1013option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1014option contstats (*) X X X -
1015option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1016option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1017option forceclose (*) X X X X
1018-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1019option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001020option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001021option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001022option http-server-close (*) X X X X
1023option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1024option httpchk X - X X
1025option httpclose (*) X X X X
1026option httplog X X X X
1027option http_proxy (*) X X X X
1028option independant-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001029option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001030option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1031option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1032option logasap (*) X X X -
1033option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001034option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001035option nolinger (*) X X X X
1036option originalto X X X X
1037option persist (*) X - X X
1038option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001039option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001040option smtpchk X - X X
1041option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1042option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1043option splice-request (*) X X X X
1044option splice-response (*) X X X X
1045option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1046option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1047-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1048option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1049option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1050option tcpka X X X X
1051option tcplog X X X X
1052option transparent (*) X - X X
1053persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1054rate-limit sessions X X X -
1055redirect - X X X
1056redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1057redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1058reqadd - X X X
1059reqallow - X X X
1060reqdel - X X X
1061reqdeny - X X X
1062reqiallow - X X X
1063reqidel - X X X
1064reqideny - X X X
1065reqipass - X X X
1066reqirep - X X X
1067reqisetbe - X X X
1068reqitarpit - X X X
1069reqpass - X X X
1070reqrep - X X X
1071-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1072reqsetbe - X X X
1073reqtarpit - X X X
1074retries X - X X
1075rspadd - X X X
1076rspdel - X X X
1077rspdeny - X X X
1078rspidel - X X X
1079rspideny - X X X
1080rspirep - X X X
1081rsprep - X X X
1082server - - X X
1083source X - X X
1084srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001085stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001086stats auth X - X X
1087stats enable X - X X
1088stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001089stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001090stats realm X - X X
1091stats refresh X - X X
1092stats scope X - X X
1093stats show-desc X - X X
1094stats show-legends X - X X
1095stats show-node X - X X
1096stats uri X - X X
1097-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1098stick match - - X X
1099stick on - - X X
1100stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001101stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001102stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001103tcp-request connection - X X -
1104tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001105tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001106tcp-response content - - X X
1107tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001108timeout check X - X X
1109timeout client X X X -
1110timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1111timeout connect X - X X
1112timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1113timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1114timeout http-request X X X X
1115timeout queue X - X X
1116timeout server X - X X
1117timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1118timeout tarpit X X X X
1119transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001120unique-id-format X X X -
1121unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001122use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001123use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001124------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1125 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001126
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001127
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011284.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1129---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001130
1131This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1132
1133
1134acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1135 Declare or complete an access list.
1136 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1137 no | yes | yes | yes
1138 Example:
1139 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1140 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1141 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1142
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001143 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001144
1145
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001146appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1147 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001148 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1149 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1150 no | no | yes | yes
1151 Arguments :
1152 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1153 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1154
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001155 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001156 checked in each cookie value.
1157
1158 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1159 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1160 milliseconds.
1161
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001162 request-learn
1163 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1164 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1165 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1166 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1167 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1168 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1169
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001170 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1171 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1172 data following this prefix.
1173
1174 Example :
1175 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1176
1177 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1178 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1179
1180 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1181 2 modes are currently supported :
1182 - path-parameters :
1183 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1184 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1185 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1186 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1187 - query-string :
1188 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1189 query string.
1190
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001191 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1192 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1193 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1194 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001195 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1196 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1197 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001198 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1199 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1200
1201 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1202
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001203 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1204 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1205 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1206
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001207 Example :
1208 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1209
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001210 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1211 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001212
1213
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001214backlog <conns>
1215 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1216 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1217 yes | yes | yes | no
1218 Arguments :
1219 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1220 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
1221 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
1222
1223 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1224 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1225 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1226 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1227 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1228 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1229 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1230 backlog parameter.
1231
1232 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1233 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1234 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1235
1236 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1237
1238
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001239balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001240balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001241 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1242 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1243 yes | no | yes | yes
1244 Arguments :
1245 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1246 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1247 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1248 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1249
1250 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1251 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1252 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1253 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001254 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
1255 design to 4128 active servers per backend. Note that in some
1256 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1257 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1258 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1259 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1260 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1261 it, so that you don't worry.
1262
1263 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1264 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1265 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1266 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1267 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1268 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1269 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1270 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001271
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001272 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1273 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1274 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1275 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1276 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1277 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1278 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1279 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1280
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001281 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
1282 connection. The servers are choosen from the lowest numeric
1283 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1284 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001285 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001286 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1287 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1288 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1289 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1290 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001291 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1292 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1293 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1294 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1295 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1296 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001297
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001298 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1299 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1300 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1301 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1302 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1303 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1304 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1305 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001306 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001307 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001308 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1309 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1310 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001311
1312 uri The left part of the URI (before the question mark) is hashed
1313 and divided by the total weight of the running servers. The
1314 result designates which server will receive the request. This
1315 ensures that a same URI will always be directed to the same
1316 server as long as no server goes up or down. This is used
1317 with proxy caches and anti-virus proxies in order to maximize
1318 the cache hit rate. Note that this algorithm may only be used
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001319 in an HTTP backend. This algorithm is static by default,
1320 which means that changing a server's weight on the fly will
1321 have no effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001322
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001323 This algorithm support two optional parameters "len" and
1324 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1325 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1326 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1327 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1328 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1329 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1330 URIs start with a leading "/".
1331
1332 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1333 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1334 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1335 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1336
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001337 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001338 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1339
1340 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
1341 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
Willy Tarreau61a21a32011-03-01 20:35:49 +01001342 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
1343 ('?') in the URL. Optionally, specify a number of octets to
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001344 wait for before attempting to search the message body. If the
1345 entity can not be searched, then round robin is used for each
1346 request. For instance, if your clients always send the LB
1347 parameter in the first 128 bytes, then specify that. The
1348 default is 48. The entity data will not be scanned until the
1349 required number of octets have arrived at the gateway, this
1350 is the minimum of: (default/max_wait, Content-Length or first
1351 chunk length). If Content-Length is missing or zero, it does
1352 not need to wait for more data than the client promised to
1353 send. When Content-Length is present and larger than
1354 <max_wait>, then waiting is limited to <max_wait> and it is
1355 assumed that this will be enough data to search for the
1356 presence of the parameter. In the unlikely event that
1357 Transfer-Encoding: chunked is used, only the first chunk is
1358 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
1359 be randomly balanced if at all.
1360
1361 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1362 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1363 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1364 server will receive the request.
1365
1366 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1367 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1368 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1369 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1370 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001371 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1372 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1373 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001374
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001375 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP request.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001376 Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function, the header
1377 name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the header is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001378 absent or if it does not contain any value, the roundrobin
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001379 algorithm is applied instead.
1380
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001381 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001382 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1383 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1384 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1385
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001386 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1387 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1388 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1389
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001390 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001391 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001392 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1393 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1394 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1395 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1396 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1397 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001398 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001399 used instead.
1400
1401 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1402 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1403 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1404 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1405
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001406 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1407 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1408 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1409
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001410 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
1411
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001412 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001413 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1414 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001415
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001416 balance uri [len <len>] [depth <depth>]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001417 balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001418
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001419 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1420 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1421 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001422
1423 Examples :
1424 balance roundrobin
1425 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001426 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001427 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1428 balance hdr(host)
1429 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001430
1431 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1432 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1433
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001434 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001435 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1436 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1437 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1438 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1439
1440 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1441 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1442 defaults to 16 kB.
1443
1444 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1445 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1446
1447 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1448 Round Robin.
1449
1450 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1451 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1452 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1453 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1454
1455 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1456
1457 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001458 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001459 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1460 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1461 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001462
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001463 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1464 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001465
1466
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001467bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...]
1468bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] interface <interface>
1469bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] mss <maxseg>
1470bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] transparent
1471bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] id <id>
1472bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] name <name>
1473bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] defer-accept
Willy Tarreau71c814e2010-10-29 21:56:16 +02001474bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] accept-proxy
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001475bind /<path> [, ...]
1476bind /<path> [, ...] mode <mode>
1477bind /<path> [, ...] [ user <user> | uid <uid> ]
1478bind /<path> [, ...] [ group <user> | gid <gid> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001479 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1480 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1481 no | yes | yes | no
1482 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001483 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1484 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1485 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1486 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001487 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001488
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001489 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1490 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001491 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1492 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1493 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001494 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1495 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1496 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1497 the range.
1498
1499 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1500 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1501 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1502 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1503 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1504 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1505 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
1506 privileges to start the program, which are independant of
1507 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001508
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001509 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1510 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1511 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1512 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1513 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1514 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1515 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1516 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1517
Willy Tarreau5e6e2042009-02-04 17:19:29 +01001518 <interface> is an optional physical interface name. This is currently
1519 only supported on Linux. The interface must be a physical
1520 interface, not an aliased interface. When specified, all
1521 addresses on the same line will only be accepted if the
1522 incoming packet physically come through the designated
1523 interface. It is also possible to bind multiple frontends to
1524 the same address if they are bound to different interfaces.
1525 Note that binding to a physical interface requires root
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001526 privileges. This parameter is only compatible with TCP
1527 sockets.
Willy Tarreau5e6e2042009-02-04 17:19:29 +01001528
Willy Tarreaube1b9182009-06-14 18:48:19 +02001529 <maxseg> is an optional TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be
1530 advertised on incoming connections. This can be used to force
1531 a lower MSS for certain specific ports, for instance for
1532 connections passing through a VPN. Note that this relies on a
1533 kernel feature which is theorically supported under Linux but
1534 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not
Willy Tarreau48a7e722010-12-24 15:26:39 +01001535 work on other operating systems. It may also not change the
1536 advertised value but change the effective size of outgoing
1537 segments. The commonly advertised value on Ethernet networks
1538 is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is positive,
1539 it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it
1540 will indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's
1541 advertised MSS for outgoing segments. This parameter is only
1542 compatible with TCP sockets.
Willy Tarreaube1b9182009-06-14 18:48:19 +02001543
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02001544 <id> is a persistent value for socket ID. Must be positive and
1545 unique in the proxy. An unused value will automatically be
1546 assigned if unset. Can only be used when defining only a
1547 single socket.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02001548
1549 <name> is an optional name provided for stats
1550
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001551 <mode> is the octal mode used to define access permissions on the
1552 UNIX socket. It can also be set by default in the global
1553 section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms
1554 simply ignore this.
1555
1556 <user> is the name of user that will be marked owner of the UNIX
1557 socket. It can also be set by default in the global
1558 section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms
1559 simply ignore this.
1560
1561 <group> is the name of a group that will be used to create the UNIX
1562 socket. It can also be set by default in the global section's
1563 "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms simply ignore
1564 this.
1565
1566 <uid> is the uid of user that will be marked owner of the UNIX
1567 socket. It can also be set by default in the global section's
1568 "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms simply ignore
1569 this.
1570
1571 <gid> is the gid of a group that will be used to create the UNIX
1572 socket. It can also be set by default in the global section's
1573 "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms simply ignore
1574 this.
1575
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001576 transparent is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain
1577 Linux kernels. It indicates that the addresses will be bound
1578 even if they do not belong to the local machine. Any packet
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001579 targeting any of these addresses will be caught just as if
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001580 the address was locally configured. This normally requires
1581 that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with
1582 the default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for
1583 the specified port. This keyword is available only when
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001584 HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1. This parameter is
1585 only compatible with TCP sockets.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001586
Willy Tarreau59f89202010-10-02 11:54:00 +02001587 defer-accept is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain
Willy Tarreaucb6cd432009-10-13 07:34:14 +02001588 Linux kernels. It states that a connection will only be
1589 accepted once some data arrive on it, or at worst after the
1590 first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols for
1591 which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly
1592 improve performance by ensuring that most of the request is
1593 already available when the connection is accepted. On the
1594 other hand, it will not be able to detect connections which
1595 don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
1596 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is
1597 never accepted until the client talks. This can cause issues
1598 with front firewalls which would see an established
1599 connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV.
1600
Willy Tarreau71c814e2010-10-29 21:56:16 +02001601 accept-proxy is an optional keyword which enforces use of the PROXY
1602 protocol over any connection accepted by this listener. The
1603 PROXY protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of the
1604 incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used,
1605 with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules
1606 which will only see the real connection address. Logs will
1607 reflect the addresses indicated in the protocol, unless it is
1608 violated, in which case the real address will still be used.
1609 This keyword combined with support from external components
1610 can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
1611 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and
1612 not even always usable.
1613
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001614 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1615 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1616 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1617 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1618 in a frontend.
1619
1620 Example :
1621 listen http_proxy
1622 bind :80,:443
1623 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001624 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001625
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001626 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreau71c814e2010-10-29 21:56:16 +02001627 documentation.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001628
1629
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001630bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32> ] ...
1631 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1632 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1633 yes | yes | yes | yes
1634 Arguments :
1635 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1636 may be used to override a default value.
1637
1638 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...31. This
1639 option may be combined with other numbers.
1640
1641 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...32. This
1642 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1643 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1644 missing from all processes.
1645
1646 number The instance will be enabled on this process number, between
1647 1 and 32. You must be careful not to reference a process
1648 number greater than the configured global.nbproc, otherwise
1649 some instances might be missing from all processes.
1650
1651 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1652 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1653 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1654 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1655 and 'even' instances.
1656
1657 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 processes using
1658 this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups. Please
1659 note that 'all' really means all processes and is not limited to the first
1660 32.
1661
1662 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1663 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1664
1665 Example :
1666 listen app_ip1
1667 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001668 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001669
1670 listen app_ip2
1671 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001672 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001673
1674 listen management
1675 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001676 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001677
1678 See also : "nbproc" in global section.
1679
1680
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001681block { if | unless } <condition>
1682 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1683 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1684 no | yes | yes | yes
1685
1686 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1687 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001688 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001689 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001690 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1691 "block" statements per instance.
1692
1693 Example:
1694 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1695 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1696 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1697 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1698
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001699 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001700
1701
1702capture cookie <name> len <length>
1703 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1704 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1705 no | yes | yes | no
1706 Arguments :
1707 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1708 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1709 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1710 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1711 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1712
1713 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1714 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1715 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1716 right if it exceeds <length>.
1717
1718 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1719 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1720 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1721 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1722
1723 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1724 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1725 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1726
1727 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1728 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1729 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
1730 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001731 configured in the sources by default to 64 characters. It is not possible to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001732 specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1733
1734 Example:
1735 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1736
1737 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001738 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001739
1740
1741capture request header <name> len <length>
1742 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified request header.
1743 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1744 no | yes | yes | no
1745 Arguments :
1746 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001747 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001748 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
1749 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1750 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1751
1752 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1753 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1754 it exceeds <length>.
1755
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001756 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001757 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
1758 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001759 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
1760 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
1761 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
1762 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001763 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001764 environments to find where the request came from.
1765
1766 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
1767 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
1768 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
1769 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001770
1771 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers, but each capture
1772 is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent for a
1773 same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It is not
1774 possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1775
1776 Example:
1777 capture request header Host len 15
1778 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
1779 capture request header Referrer len 15
1780
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001781 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001782 about logging.
1783
1784
1785capture response header <name> len <length>
1786 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified response header.
1787 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1788 no | yes | yes | no
1789 Arguments :
1790 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001791 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001792 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
1793 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1794 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1795
1796 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1797 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1798 it exceeds <length>.
1799
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001800 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001801 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
1802 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
1803 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001804 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
1805 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
1806 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
1807 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001808
1809 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers, but each
1810 capture is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent
1811 for a same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It
1812 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1813
1814 Example:
1815 capture response header Content-length len 9
1816 capture response header Location len 15
1817
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001818 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001819 about logging.
1820
1821
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001822clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001823 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
1824 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1825 yes | yes | yes | no
1826 Arguments :
1827 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1828 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1829 as explained at the top of this document.
1830
1831 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
1832 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
1833 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
1834 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
1835 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
1836 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
1837 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
1838 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001839 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001840 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
1841 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
1842
1843 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
1844 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1845 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1846 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1847 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
1848 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1849
1850 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
1851 Please use "timeout client" instead.
1852
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01001853 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
1854 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001855
1856
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001857contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001858 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
1859 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1860 yes | no | yes | yes
1861 Arguments :
1862 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1863 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1864 as explained at the top of this document.
1865
1866 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001867 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001868 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001869 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
1870 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
1871 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
1872 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
1873
1874 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
1875 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1876 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1877 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1878 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
1879 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1880
1881 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
1882 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
1883 instead.
1884
1885 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
1886 "timeout server", "contimeout".
1887
1888
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02001889cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001890 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ domain <domain> ]*
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02001891 [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001892 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
1893 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1894 yes | no | yes | yes
1895 Arguments :
1896 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
1897 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
1898 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
1899 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
1900 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
1901 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
1902 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
1903 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
1904 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
1905
1906 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
1907 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
1908 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
1909 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
1910 headers is left to the application. The application can then
1911 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
1912 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
1913 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
1914 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
1915 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
1916 "insert" and "prefix".
1917
1918 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001919 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001920
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001921 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001922 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
1923 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
1924 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
1925 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
1926 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
1927 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
1928 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
1929 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
1930 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
1931 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001932
1933 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
1934 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
1935 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
1936 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
1937 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
1938 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
1939 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
1940 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
1941 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
1942 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02001943 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
1944 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
1945 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001946
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001947 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
1948 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
1949 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001950 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
1951 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
1952 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
1953 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02001954 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
1955 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
1956 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001957
1958 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
1959 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
1960 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
1961 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
1962 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
1963 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
1964 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
1965 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
1966 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
1967
1968 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
1969 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
1970 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
1971 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
1972 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
1973 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
1974 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
1975 persistence cookie in the cache.
1976 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
1977
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001978 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
1979 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
1980 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
1981 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
1982 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
1983 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
1984 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
1985 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
1986 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
1987 they logout.
1988
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02001989 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001990 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01001991 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
1992 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
1993 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
1994 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
1995 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
1996 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02001997
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02001998 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
1999 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2000 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2001 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2002 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2003 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2004 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2005 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2006 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2007 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2008 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2009 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2010 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2011 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2012 the site.
2013
2014 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2015 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2016 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2017 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2018 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2019 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2020 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2021 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2022 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2023 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2024 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2025 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2026 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2027 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2028 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2029 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2030
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002031 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2032 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2033 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2034 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002035
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002036 Examples :
2037 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2038 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2039 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002040 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002041
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002042 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002043 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002044
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002045
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002046default-server [param*]
2047 Change default options for a server in a backend
2048 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2049 yes | no | yes | yes
2050 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002051 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2052 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2053 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2054 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002055
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002056 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002057 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2058
2059 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002060
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002061
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002062default_backend <backend>
2063 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2064 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2065 yes | yes | yes | no
2066 Arguments :
2067 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2068
2069 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2070 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2071 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2072 will catch all undetermined requests.
2073
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002074 Example :
2075
2076 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2077 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2078 default_backend dynamic
2079
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002080 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2081
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002082
2083disabled
2084 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2085 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2086 yes | yes | yes | yes
2087 Arguments : none
2088
2089 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2090 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2091 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2092 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2093 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2094 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2095 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2096
2097 See also : "enabled"
2098
2099
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002100dispatch <address>:<port>
2101 Set a default server address
2102 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2103 no | no | yes | yes
2104 Arguments : none
2105
2106 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2107 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2108 during start-up.
2109
2110 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2111 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2112 possible with normal servers.
2113
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002114 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002115 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2116 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2117 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2118 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2119
2120 See also : "server"
2121
2122
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002123enabled
2124 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2125 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2126 yes | yes | yes | yes
2127 Arguments : none
2128
2129 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2130 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2131
2132 See also : "disabled"
2133
2134
2135errorfile <code> <file>
2136 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2137 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2138 yes | yes | yes | yes
2139 Arguments :
2140 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002141 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002142
2143 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002144 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002145 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002146 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2147 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002148
2149 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2150 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2151 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2152
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002153 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2154
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002155 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2156 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2157 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2158 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2159
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002160 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2161 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2162 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2163 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2164 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2165 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2166
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002167 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2168 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2169 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002170 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002171 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2172
2173 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2174
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002175 Example :
2176 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
2177 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2178 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2179
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002180
2181errorloc <code> <url>
2182errorloc302 <code> <url>
2183 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2184 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2185 yes | yes | yes | yes
2186 Arguments :
2187 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002188 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002189
2190 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2191 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2192 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2193 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2194 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2195
2196 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2197 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2198 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2199
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002200 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2201
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002202 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2203 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2204 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2205 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2206 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2207 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2208 request.
2209
2210 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2211
2212
2213errorloc303 <code> <url>
2214 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2215 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2216 yes | yes | yes | yes
2217 Arguments :
2218 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2219 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2220
2221 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2222 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2223 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2224 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2225 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2226
2227 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2228 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2229 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2230
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002231 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2232
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002233 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2234 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2235 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2236 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002237 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002238
2239 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2240
2241
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002242force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2243 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2244 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2245 no | yes | yes | yes
2246
2247 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2248 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2249 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2250 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2251 marked down for maintenance operations.
2252
2253 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2254 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2255 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2256 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2257 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2258 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2259 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2260 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2261 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2262
2263 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2264 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2265 is used.
2266
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002267 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002268 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002269
2270
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002271fullconn <conns>
2272 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2273 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2274 yes | no | yes | yes
2275 Arguments :
2276 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2277 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2278
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002279 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002280 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002281 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002282 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2283 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2284 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2285 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2286 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002287 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002288
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002289 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2290 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
2291 backend. That way it's safe to leave it unset.
2292
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002293 Example :
2294 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2295 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2296 # connections.
2297 backend dynamic
2298 fullconn 10000
2299 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2300 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2301
2302 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2303
2304
2305grace <time>
2306 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2307 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002308 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002309 Arguments :
2310 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2311 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2312 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2313
2314 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2315 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002316 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002317 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2318
2319 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2320 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2321 simplify it.
2322
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002323
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002324hash-type <method>
2325 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2326 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2327 yes | no | yes | yes
2328 Arguments :
2329 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2330 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but will
2331 be static in that weight changes while a server is up will be
2332 ignored. This means that there will be no slow start. Also,
2333 since a server is selected by its position in the array, most
2334 mappings are changed when the server count changes. This means
2335 that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is added
2336 to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to different
2337 servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for instance.
2338
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002339 avalanche this mechanism uses the default map-based hashing described
2340 above but applies a full avalanche hash before performing the
2341 mapping. The result is a slightly less smooth hash for most
2342 situations, but the hash becomes better than pure map-based
2343 hashes when the number of servers is a multiple of the size of
2344 the input set. When using URI hash with a number of servers
2345 multiple of 64, it's desirable to change the hash type to
2346 this value.
2347
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002348 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2349 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2350 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2351 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2352 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2353 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a server
2354 is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings are
2355 redistributed, making it an ideal algorithm for caches.
2356 However, due to its principle, the algorithm will never be very
2357 smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a server's
2358 weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution. In order
2359 to get the same distribution on multiple load balancers, it is
2360 important that all servers have the same IDs.
2361
2362 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages.
2363
2364 See also : "balance", "server"
2365
2366
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002367http-check disable-on-404
2368 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2369 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002370 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002371 Arguments : none
2372
2373 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2374 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2375 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2376 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2377 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2378 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2379 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2380 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002381 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2382 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2383 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2384
2385 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2386
2387
2388http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
2389 Make HTTP health checks consider reponse contents or specific status codes
2390 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002391 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002392 Arguments :
2393 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2394 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
2395 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceeded by an
2396 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2397 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2398 details on the supported keywords.
2399
2400 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2401 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2402 with the usual backslash ('\').
2403
2404 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2405 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2406 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2407 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2408 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2409
2410 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
2411 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2412 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2413 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2414 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2415
2416 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
2417 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2418 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2419 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2420 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2421 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2422
2423 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
2424 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2425 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2426 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2427 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2428 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2429 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2430 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2431 trace).
2432
2433 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
2434 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2435 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2436 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2437 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2438 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2439 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2440 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2441
2442 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2443 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2444 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2445 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2446 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2447 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2448 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2449 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2450
2451 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2452 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2453
2454 Examples :
2455 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002456 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002457
2458 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002459 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002460
2461 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002462 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002463
2464 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002465 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002466
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002467 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002468
2469
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002470http-check send-state
2471 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2472 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2473 yes | no | yes | yes
2474 Arguments : none
2475
2476 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2477 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2478 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2479 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2480 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2481
2482 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2483 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2484 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2485 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2486 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2487 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2488 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2489 checked in multiple backends.
2490
2491 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2492 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2493
2494 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2495 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2496 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2497 one fails.
2498
2499 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2500 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2501 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2502
2503 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2504 server's queue.
2505
2506 Example of a header received by the application server :
2507 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2508 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2509
2510 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2511
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002512http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002513 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002514 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2515
2516 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2517 no | yes | yes | yes
2518
2519 These set of options allow to fine control access to a
2520 frontend/listen/backend. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
2521 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002522 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
2523 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002524 should be asked to enter a username and password.
2525
2526 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
2527 instance.
2528
2529 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002530 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
2531 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
2532 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002533
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002534 http-request allow if nagios
2535 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
2536 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
2537 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002538
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002539 Example:
2540 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002541
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002542 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002543
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002544 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
2545 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002546
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05002547http-send-name-header [<header>]
2548 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
2549
2550 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2551 yes | no | yes | yes
2552
2553 Arguments :
2554
2555 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
2556
2557 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
2558 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
2559 is added with the header string proved.
2560
2561 See also : "server"
2562
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002563id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02002564 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
2565 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2566 no | yes | yes | yes
2567 Arguments : none
2568
2569 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
2570 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
2571 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002572
2573
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002574ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2575 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
2576 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2577 no | yes | yes | yes
2578
2579 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
2580 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
2581 and running).
2582
2583 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2584 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
2585 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
2586 oftenly don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
2587 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
2588
2589 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
2590 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
2591
2592 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2593 "unless" condition is met.
2594
2595 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
2596
2597
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002598log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002599log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002600no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002601 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
2602 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2603 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002604
2605 Prefix :
2606 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
2607 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
2608 prefix does not allow arguments.
2609
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002610 Arguments :
2611 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
2612 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
2613 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
2614 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
2615 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
2616 parameter.
2617
2618 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
2619 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
2620
2621 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
2622 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2623 standard syslog port).
2624
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01002625 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
2626 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2627 standard syslog port).
2628
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002629 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
2630 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
2631 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
2632 appropriately writeable).
2633
2634 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
2635
2636 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
2637 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
2638 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
2639
2640 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
2641 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
2642 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002643 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
2644 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
2645 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
2646 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
2647 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002648
2649 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
2650
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002651 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
2652 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
2653 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002654
2655 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
2656 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
2657 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
2658 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
2659
2660 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
2661 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002662
2663 Example :
2664 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002665 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
2666 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002667
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01002668log-format <string>
2669 Allows you to custom a log line.
2670
2671 See also : Custom Log Format (8.2.4)
2672
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002673
2674maxconn <conns>
2675 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
2676 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2677 yes | yes | yes | no
2678 Arguments :
2679 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
2680 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
2681 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
2682 closes.
2683
2684 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
2685 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
2686 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
2687 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
2688 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
2689 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
2690 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
2691 properly tuned.
2692
2693 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
2694 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
2695 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
2696
2697 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
2698
2699
2700mode { tcp|http|health }
2701 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
2702 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2703 yes | yes | yes | yes
2704 Arguments :
2705 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
2706 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
2707 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
2708 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
2709
2710 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
2711 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
2712 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
2713 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
2714 brings HAProxy most of its value.
2715
2716 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
2717 to incoming connections and close the connection. Nothing will be
2718 logged. This mode is used to reply to external components health
2719 checks. This mode is deprecated and should not be used anymore as
2720 it is possible to do the same and even better by combining TCP or
2721 HTTP modes with the "monitor" keyword.
2722
2723 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
2724 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
2725 will be refused.
2726
2727 Example :
2728 defaults http_instances
2729 mode http
2730
2731 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
2732
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002733
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002734monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002735 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002736 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2737 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002738 Arguments :
2739 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
2740 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002741 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002742 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
2743 backend and its backup.
2744
2745 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
2746 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
2747 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
2748 servers in a list of backends.
2749
2750 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
2751 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
2752 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
2753 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
2754 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
2755 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
2756 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002757 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
2758 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002759
2760 Example:
2761 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002762 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002763 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
2764 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
2765 monitor-uri /site_alive
2766 monitor fail if site_dead
2767
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002768 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002769
2770
2771monitor-net <source>
2772 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
2773 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2774 yes | yes | yes | no
2775 Arguments :
2776 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
2777 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
2778 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
2779 followed by a mask.
2780
2781 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
2782 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002783 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002784 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
2785
2786 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
2787 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
2788 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
2789 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
2790 running without forwarding the request to a backend server.
2791
2792 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
2793 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
2794 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
2795 nothing more. Right now, it is not possible to set failure conditions on
2796 requests caught by "monitor-net".
2797
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01002798 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
2799 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
2800
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002801 Example :
2802 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
2803 frontend www
2804 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
2805
2806 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
2807
2808
2809monitor-uri <uri>
2810 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
2811 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2812 yes | yes | yes | no
2813 Arguments :
2814 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
2815 health status instead of forwarding the request.
2816
2817 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
2818 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
2819 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
2820 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
2821 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
2822 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
2823 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
2824 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
2825
2826 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
2827 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
2828 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
2829 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
2830 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
2831 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
2832
2833 Example :
2834 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
2835 frontend www
2836 mode http
2837 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
2838
2839 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
2840
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002841
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002842option abortonclose
2843no option abortonclose
2844 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
2845 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2846 yes | no | yes | yes
2847 Arguments : none
2848
2849 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
2850 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
2851 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
2852 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002853 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002854 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
2855 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
2856 encountered while delivering the response.
2857
2858 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
2859 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
2860 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
2861 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
2862 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
2863 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002864 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002865 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002866 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002867 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
2868 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
2869 still not served and not pollute the servers.
2870
2871 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
2872 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
2873 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
2874 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
2875 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
2876 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
2877 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
2878 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002879 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002880
2881 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2882 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2883
2884 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
2885
2886
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002887option accept-invalid-http-request
2888no option accept-invalid-http-request
2889 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
2890 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2891 yes | yes | yes | no
2892 Arguments : none
2893
2894 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
2895 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
2896 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
2897 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
2898 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
2899 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
2900 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
2901 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01002902 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
2903 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
2904 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
2905 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
2906 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
2907 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002908
2909 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
2910 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
2911 been confirmed.
2912
2913 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
2914 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01002915 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
2916 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002917 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
2918
2919 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2920 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2921
2922 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
2923 stats socket.
2924
2925
2926option accept-invalid-http-response
2927no option accept-invalid-http-response
2928 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
2929 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2930 yes | no | yes | yes
2931 Arguments : none
2932
2933 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
2934 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
2935 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
2936 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
2937 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
2938 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
2939 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
2940 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
2941 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
2942
2943 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
2944 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
2945 been confirmed.
2946
2947 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
2948 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
2949 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
2950 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
2951
2952 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2953 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2954
2955 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
2956 stats socket.
2957
2958
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002959option allbackups
2960no option allbackups
2961 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
2962 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2963 yes | no | yes | yes
2964 Arguments : none
2965
2966 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
2967 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
2968 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
2969 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
2970 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
2971 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
2972 order between the backup servers anymore.
2973
2974 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
2975 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
2976
2977 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2978 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2979
2980
2981option checkcache
2982no option checkcache
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002983 Analyze all server responses and block requests with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002984 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2985 yes | no | yes | yes
2986 Arguments : none
2987
2988 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
2989 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002990 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002991 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
2992 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002993 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002994
2995 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002996 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002997 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002998 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
2999 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003000 to the client are :
3001 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003002 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003003 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003004 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
3005 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
3006 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
3007 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
3008 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
3009 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
3010 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
3011 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
3012 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
3013 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
3014 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
3015
3016 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003017 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003018 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003019 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003020 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
3021
3022 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
3023 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003024 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003025 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
3026
3027 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3028 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3029
3030
3031option clitcpka
3032no option clitcpka
3033 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
3034 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3035 yes | yes | yes | no
3036 Arguments : none
3037
3038 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3039 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3040 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3041 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3042
3043 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3044 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3045 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3046 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3047
3048 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3049 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3050 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3051 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3052 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3053
3054 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3055
3056 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3057 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3058 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
3059
3060 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3061 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3062
3063 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
3064
3065
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003066option contstats
3067 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
3068 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3069 yes | yes | yes | no
3070 Arguments : none
3071
3072 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
3073 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
3074 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
3075 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
3076 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
3077 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
3078 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
3079
3080
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003081option dontlog-normal
3082no option dontlog-normal
3083 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
3084 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3085 yes | yes | yes | no
3086 Arguments : none
3087
3088 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3089 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3090 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3091 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3092 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3093 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3094 logged.
3095
3096 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3097 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3098 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3099
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003100 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003101 logging.
3102
3103
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003104option dontlognull
3105no option dontlognull
3106 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3107 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3108 yes | yes | yes | no
3109 Arguments : none
3110
3111 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3112 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3113 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3114 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3115 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3116 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3117 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3118
3119 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3120 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3121 would not be logged.
3122
3123 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3124 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3125
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003126 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003127
3128
3129option forceclose
3130no option forceclose
3131 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3132 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003133 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003134 Arguments : none
3135
3136 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3137 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3138 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3139 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3140 global session times in the logs.
3141
3142 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003143 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003144 to respond. This option implicitly enables the "httpclose" option. Note that
3145 this option also enables the parsing of the full request and response, which
3146 means we can close the connection to the server very quickly, releasing some
3147 resources earlier than with httpclose.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003148
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003149 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3150 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3151 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
3152
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003153 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3154 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3155
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003156 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003157
3158
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003159option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003160 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
3161 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3162 yes | yes | yes | yes
3163 Arguments :
3164 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3165 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003166 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003167 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003168
3169 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
3170 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
3171 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
3172 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
3173 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
3174 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
3175 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003176 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
3177 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3178 possible that the client has already brought one.
3179
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003180 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003181 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003182 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
3183 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003184 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
3185 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003186
3187 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3188 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3189 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3190 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3191 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3192 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3193 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3194
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003195 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
3196 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
3197 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
3198 are under the control of the end-user.
3199
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003200 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003201 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3202 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003203 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
3204 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
3205 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003206
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003207 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
3208 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
3209 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
3210 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
3211 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003212
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003213 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003214 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
3215 frontend www
3216 mode http
3217 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
3218
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003219 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
3220 backend www
3221 mode http
3222 option forwardfor header X-Client
3223
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003224 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
3225 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003226
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003227
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003228option http-no-delay
3229no option http-no-delay
3230 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
3231 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3232 yes | yes | yes | yes
3233 Arguments : none
3234
3235 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
3236 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
3237 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
3238 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
3239 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
3240 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
3241 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
3242 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
3243 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
3244 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
3245 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
3246 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
3247 affected.
3248
3249 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
3250 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
3251 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
3252 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
3253 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
3254 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
3255 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
3256 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
3257 latency environments.
3258
3259
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003260option http-pretend-keepalive
3261no option http-pretend-keepalive
3262 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
3263 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3264 yes | yes | yes | yes
3265 Arguments : none
3266
3267 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
3268 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
3269 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
3270 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
3271 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
3272 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
3273 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
3274 consider the response complete.
3275
3276 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
3277 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
3278 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
3279 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
3280 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
3281 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
3282
3283 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
3284 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
3285 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
3286 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
3287 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
3288 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
3289 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
3290
3291 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3292 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02003293 This option may be compbined with "option httpclose", which will cause
3294 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
3295 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003296
3297 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3298 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3299
3300 See also : "option forceclose" and "option http-server-close"
3301
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003302
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003303option http-server-close
3304no option http-server-close
3305 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
3306 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3307 yes | yes | yes | yes
3308 Arguments : none
3309
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003310 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3311 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. Setting
3312 "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server
3313 side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on
3314 the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
3315 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
3316 resources, similarly to "option forceclose". It also permits non-keepalive
3317 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
3318 conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note that some servers do not
3319 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
3320 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
3321 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003322
3323 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3324 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3325 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3326 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01003327 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3328 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003329
3330 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3331 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003332 It is worth noting that "option forceclose" has precedence over "option
3333 http-server-close" and that combining "http-server-close" with "httpclose"
3334 basically achieve the same result as "forceclose".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003335
3336 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3337 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3338
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003339 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
3340 "option httpclose" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003341
3342
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003343option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003344no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003345 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
3346 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3347 yes | yes | yes | no
3348 Arguments : none
3349
3350 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
3351 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
3352 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
3353 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
3354 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
3355 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
3356 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
3357
3358 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
3359 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
3360 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
3361 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
3362 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
3363 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
3364 request along its whole life.
3365
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01003366 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
3367 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
3368 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
3369 front of an existing proxy.
3370
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003371 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
3372
3373 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
3374 http-server-close".
3375
3376
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003377option httpchk
3378option httpchk <uri>
3379option httpchk <method> <uri>
3380option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
3381 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
3382 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3383 yes | no | yes | yes
3384 Arguments :
3385 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
3386 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
3387 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
3388 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
3389 ones.
3390
3391 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
3392 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
3393 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
3394
3395 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
3396 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
3397 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
3398 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
3399 after "\r\n" following the version string.
3400
3401 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
3402 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
3403 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
3404 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
3405 the lack of any response.
3406
3407 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
3408
3409 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
3410 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
3411 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
3412
3413 Examples :
3414 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
3415 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
3416 backend https_relay
3417 mode tcp
3418 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
3419 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
3420
3421 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003422 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
3423 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003424
3425
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003426option httpclose
3427no option httpclose
3428 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
3429 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3430 yes | yes | yes | yes
3431 Arguments : none
3432
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003433 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3434 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. If "option
3435 httpclose" is set, it will check if a "Connection: close" header is already
3436 set in each direction, and will add one if missing. Each end should react to
3437 this by actively closing the TCP connection after each transfer, thus
3438 resulting in a switch to the HTTP close mode. Any "Connection" header
3439 different from "close" will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003440
3441 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003442 close the connection eventhough they reply "Connection: close". For this
3443 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
3444 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
3445 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
3446 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
3447 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003448
3449 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3450 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
3451 If "option forceclose" is specified too, it has precedence over "httpclose".
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003452 If "option http-server-close" is enabled at the same time as "httpclose", it
3453 basically achieves the same result as "option forceclose".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003454
3455 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3456 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3457
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003458 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
3459 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003460
3461
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003462option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003463 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
3464 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3465 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003466 Arguments :
3467 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
3468 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
3469 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
3470 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
3471 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003472
3473 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
3474 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
3475 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
3476 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
3477 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
3478 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
3479 ports.
3480
3481 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
3482
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003483 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3484 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
3485 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
3486 by default.
3487
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003488 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003489
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003490
3491option http_proxy
3492no option http_proxy
3493 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
3494 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3495 yes | yes | yes | yes
3496 Arguments : none
3497
3498 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
3499 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
3500 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
3501 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
3502 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
3503
3504 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
3505 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
3506 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
3507 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01003508 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003509 be analyzed.
3510
3511 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3512 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3513
3514 Example :
3515 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
3516 backend direct_forward
3517 option httpclose
3518 option http_proxy
3519
3520 See also : "option httpclose"
3521
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003522
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003523option independant-streams
3524no option independant-streams
3525 Enable or disable independant timeout processing for both directions
3526 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3527 yes | yes | yes | yes
3528 Arguments : none
3529
3530 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
3531 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
3532 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
3533 receive data or not.
3534
3535 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
3536 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
3537 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
3538 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
3539 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
3540 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
3541 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
3542 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
3543 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
3544 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
3545 socket buffers.
3546
3547 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
3548 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
3549 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
3550 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
3551 slow lines, so use it with caution.
3552
3553 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout server"
3554
3555
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003556option ldap-check
3557 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
3558 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3559 yes | no | yes | yes
3560 Arguments : none
3561
3562 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
3563 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
3564 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
3565 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
3566
3567 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
3568 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
3569
3570 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
3571 configure it.
3572
3573 Example :
3574 option ldap-check
3575
3576 See also : "option httpchk"
3577
3578
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003579option log-health-checks
3580no option log-health-checks
3581 Enable or disable logging of health checks
3582 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3583 yes | no | yes | yes
3584 Arguments : none
3585
3586 Enable health checks logging so it possible to check for example what
3587 was happening before a server crash. Failed health check are logged if
3588 server is UP and succeeded health checks if server is DOWN, so the amount
3589 of additional information is limited.
3590
3591 If health check logging is enabled no health check status is printed
3592 when servers is set up UP/DOWN/ENABLED/DISABLED.
3593
3594 See also: "log" and section 8 about logging.
3595
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003596
3597option log-separate-errors
3598no option log-separate-errors
3599 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
3600 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3601 yes | yes | yes | no
3602 Arguments : none
3603
3604 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
3605 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
3606 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
3607 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
3608 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
3609 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
3610 provides very important information.
3611
3612 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
3613 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
3614 error logs.
3615
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003616 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003617 logging.
3618
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003619
3620option logasap
3621no option logasap
3622 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
3623 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3624 yes | yes | yes | no
3625 Arguments : none
3626
3627 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
3628 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
3629 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
3630 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
3631 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
3632 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
3633 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003634 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003635 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
3636 bytes are expected to be transferred.
3637
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003638 Examples :
3639 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
3640 mode http
3641 option httplog
3642 option logasap
3643 log 192.168.2.200 local3
3644
3645 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
3646 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
3647 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
3648 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
3649
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003650 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003651 logging.
3652
3653
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003654option mysql-check [ user <username> ]
3655 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003656 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3657 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003658 Arguments :
3659 user <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting
3660 to MySQL server.
3661
3662 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
3663 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
3664 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
3665 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
3666 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
3667 in the MySQL table, like this :
3668
3669 USE mysql;
3670 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
3671 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
3672
3673 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
3674 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
3675 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
3676 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
3677 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
3678 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
3679 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
3680 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
3681 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
3682
3683 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
3684 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003685
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02003686 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003687
3688 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
3689 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
3690 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3691 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3692 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
3693 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
3694
3695 See also: "option httpchk"
3696
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003697option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
3698 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
3699 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3700 yes | no | yes | yes
3701 Arguments :
3702 user <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting
3703 to PostgreSQL server.
3704
3705 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
3706 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
3707 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
3708 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
3709
3710 See also: "option httpchk"
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003711
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003712option nolinger
3713no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003714 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003715 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3716 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003717 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003718
3719 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
3720 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
3721 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
3722 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
3723 connections.
3724
3725 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
3726 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
3727 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
3728 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
3729 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
3730 this too.
3731
3732 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
3733 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
3734 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
3735
3736 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
3737 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
3738 for servers.
3739
3740 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3741 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3742
3743
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003744option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
3745 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
3746 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3747 yes | yes | yes | yes
3748 Arguments :
3749 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3750 matching <network>
3751 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
3752 header name.
3753
3754 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
3755 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
3756 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
3757 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
3758 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
3759 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
3760 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
3761 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
3762 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3763 possible that the client has already brought one.
3764
3765 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
3766 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
3767 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
3768 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
3769 header and requires different one.
3770
3771 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3772 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3773 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3774 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3775 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3776 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3777 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3778
3779 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
3780 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3781 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
3782 both are defined.
3783
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003784 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
3785 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
3786 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
3787 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
3788 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003789
3790 Examples :
3791 # Original Destination address
3792 frontend www
3793 mode http
3794 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
3795
3796 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
3797 backend www
3798 mode http
3799 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
3800
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003801 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
3802 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003803
3804
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003805option persist
3806no option persist
3807 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
3808 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3809 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003810 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003811
3812 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
3813 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
3814 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
3815 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
3816 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
3817 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
3818 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
3819 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
3820 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
3821 redirected to another valid server.
3822
3823 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3824 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3825
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003826 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003827
3828
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003829option redispatch
3830no option redispatch
3831 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
3832 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3833 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003834 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003835
3836 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
3837 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
3838 be able to access the service anymore.
3839
3840 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
3841 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
3842
3843 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
3844 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
3845 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003846
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003847 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
3848 "redisp" keywords.
3849
3850 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3851 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3852
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003853 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003854
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003855
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003856option redis-check
3857 Use redis health checks for server testing
3858 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3859 yes | no | yes | yes
3860 Arguments : none
3861
3862 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
3863 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
3864 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
3865 find the "+PONG" response message.
3866
3867 Example :
3868 option redis-check
3869
3870 See also : "option httpchk"
3871
3872
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003873option smtpchk
3874option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
3875 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
3876 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3877 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003878 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003879 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
3880 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
3881 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
3882
3883 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
3884 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
3885 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
3886
3887 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
3888 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
3889 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
3890 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
3891 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
3892 dead server.
3893
3894 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
3895 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
3896 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
3897 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
3898
3899 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
3900 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
3901 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3902 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3903 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
3904
3905 Example :
3906 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
3907
3908 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
3909
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003910
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02003911option socket-stats
3912no option socket-stats
3913
3914 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
3915 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3916 yes | yes | yes | no
3917
3918 Arguments : none
3919
3920
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003921option splice-auto
3922no option splice-auto
3923 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
3924 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3925 yes | yes | yes | yes
3926 Arguments : none
3927
3928 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3929 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
3930 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
3931 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003932 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003933 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
3934 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
3935 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
3936 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3937
3938 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
3939 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
3940 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
3941 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
3942 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
3943 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
3944 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
3945 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
3946 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
3947 keyword.
3948
3949 Example :
3950 option splice-auto
3951
3952 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3953 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3954
3955 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
3956 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3957
3958
3959option splice-request
3960no option splice-request
3961 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
3962 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3963 yes | yes | yes | yes
3964 Arguments : none
3965
3966 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3967 will user kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
3968 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
3969 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
3970 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
3971 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3972
3973 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
3974
3975 Example :
3976 option splice-request
3977
3978 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3979 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3980
3981 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
3982 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3983
3984
3985option splice-response
3986no option splice-response
3987 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
3988 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3989 yes | yes | yes | yes
3990 Arguments : none
3991
3992 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3993 will user kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
3994 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
3995 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
3996 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
3997 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3998
3999 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4000
4001 Example :
4002 option splice-response
4003
4004 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4005 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4006
4007 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
4008 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4009
4010
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004011option srvtcpka
4012no option srvtcpka
4013 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
4014 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4015 yes | no | yes | yes
4016 Arguments : none
4017
4018 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4019 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4020 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4021 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4022
4023 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4024 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4025 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4026 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4027
4028 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4029 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4030 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4031 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4032 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4033
4034 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4035
4036 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4037 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4038 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
4039
4040 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4041 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4042
4043 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
4044
4045
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004046option ssl-hello-chk
4047 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
4048 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4049 yes | no | yes | yes
4050 Arguments : none
4051
4052 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
4053 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
4054 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
4055 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
4056 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
4057 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
4058 hello message.
4059
4060 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
4061 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
4062 messages, which is appreciable.
4063
4064 See also: "option httpchk"
4065
4066
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004067option tcp-smart-accept
4068no option tcp-smart-accept
4069 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
4070 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4071 yes | yes | yes | no
4072 Arguments : none
4073
4074 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
4075 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
4076 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
4077 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
4078 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
4079 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
4080
4081 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
4082 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
4083 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
4084 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
4085
4086 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
4087 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
4088 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
4089 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
4090
4091 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
4092 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
4093 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
4094
4095 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
4096 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
4097 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
4098
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02004099 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
4100
4101
4102option tcp-smart-connect
4103no option tcp-smart-connect
4104 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
4105 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4106 yes | no | yes | yes
4107 Arguments : none
4108
4109 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
4110 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
4111 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
4112 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
4113 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
4114
4115 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
4116 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
4117 complex.
4118
4119 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
4120 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
4121 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
4122
4123 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4124 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4125
4126 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
4127
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004128
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004129option tcpka
4130 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
4131 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4132 yes | yes | yes | yes
4133 Arguments : none
4134
4135 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4136 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4137 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4138 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4139
4140 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4141 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4142 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4143 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4144
4145 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4146 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4147 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4148 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4149 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4150
4151 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4152
4153 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
4154 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
4155 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
4156 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
4157 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
4158 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
4159 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
4160 backends.
4161
4162 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
4163
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004164
4165option tcplog
4166 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
4167 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4168 yes | yes | yes | yes
4169 Arguments : none
4170
4171 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4172 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4173 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
4174 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
4175 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
4176 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
4177 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
4178 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
4179
4180 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4181
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004182 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004183
4184
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004185option transparent
4186no option transparent
4187 Enable client-side transparent proxying
4188 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01004189 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004190 Arguments : none
4191
4192 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
4193 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
4194 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
4195 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
4196 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
4197 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
4198 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
4199 appropriate server.
4200
4201 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
4202 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
4203
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01004204 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004205 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004206
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004207
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004208persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02004209persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004210 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
4211 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4212 yes | no | yes | yes
4213 Arguments :
4214 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004215 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
4216 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004217
4218 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
4219 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
4220 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
4221 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
4222 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
4223 forwarded to this server.
4224
4225 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
4226 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
4227 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004228 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004229 a single "listen" section.
4230
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004231 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
4232 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
4233 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
4234
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004235 Example :
4236 listen tse-farm
4237 bind :3389
4238 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
4239 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
4240 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
4241 # apply RDP cookie persistence
4242 persist rdp-cookie
4243 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
4244 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
4245 balance rdp-cookie
4246 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
4247 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
4248
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09004249 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
4250 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004251
4252
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004253rate-limit sessions <rate>
4254 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
4255 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4256 yes | yes | yes | no
4257 Arguments :
4258 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
4259 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
4260
4261 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
4262 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
4263 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
4264 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
4265 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
4266 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
4267
4268 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
4269 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
4270 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
4271 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
4272
4273 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
4274 listen smtp
4275 mode tcp
4276 bind :25
4277 rate-limit sessions 10
4278 server 127.0.0.1:1025
4279
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02004280 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
4281 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
4282 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004283
4284 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
4285
4286
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01004287redirect location <to> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4288redirect prefix <to> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004289 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
4290 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4291 no | yes | yes | yes
4292
4293 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01004294 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004295
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004296 Arguments :
4297 <to> With "redirect location", the exact value in <to> is placed into
4298 the HTTP "Location" header. In case of "redirect prefix", the
4299 "Location" header is built from the concatenation of <to> and the
4300 complete URI, including the query string, unless the "drop-query"
Willy Tarreaufe651a52008-11-19 21:15:17 +01004301 option is specified (see below). As a special case, if <to>
4302 equals exactly "/" in prefix mode, then nothing is inserted
4303 before the original URI. It allows one to redirect to the same
4304 URL.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004305
4306 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
4307 is desired. Only codes 301, 302 and 303 are supported, and 302 is
4308 used if no code is specified. 301 means "Moved permanently", and
4309 a browser may cache the Location. 302 means "Moved permanently"
4310 and means that the browser should not cache the redirection. 303
4311 is equivalent to 302 except that the browser will fetch the
4312 location with a GET method.
4313
4314 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
4315 expected behaviour of a redirection :
4316
4317 - "drop-query"
4318 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
4319 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
4320 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
4321 with a location-type redirect.
4322
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004323 - "append-slash"
4324 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
4325 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
4326 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
4327 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
4328
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004329 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
4330 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
4331 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
4332 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
4333 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
4334 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
4335 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
4336
4337 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
4338 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
4339 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
4340 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
4341 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
4342 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
4343 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004344
4345 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
4346 acl clear dst_port 80
4347 acl secure dst_port 8080
4348 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004349 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004350 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004351 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
4352
4353 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004354 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
4355 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
4356 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004357 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004358
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004359 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
4360 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
4361 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
4362
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004363 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004364
4365
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004366redisp (deprecated)
4367redispatch (deprecated)
4368 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4369 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4370 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004371 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004372
4373 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4374 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4375 be able to access the service anymore.
4376
4377 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
4378 redistribute them to a working server.
4379
4380 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4381 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4382 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004383
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004384 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
4385 "option redispatch" instead.
4386
4387 See also : "option redispatch"
4388
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004389
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004390reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004391 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
4392 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4393 no | yes | yes | yes
4394 Arguments :
4395 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4396 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004397 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004398
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004399 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4400 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4401
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004402 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4403 the last header of an HTTP request.
4404
4405 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4406 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4407 responses.
4408
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004409 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
4410 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
4411 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
4412
4413 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4414 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004415
4416
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004417reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4418reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004419 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4420 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4421 no | yes | yes | yes
4422 Arguments :
4423 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4424 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4425 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4426 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4427 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4428 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
4429 ignores case.
4430
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004431 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4432 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4433
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004434 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4435 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
4436 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4437 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004438 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004439
4440 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4441 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4442
4443 Example :
4444 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
4445 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4446 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4447
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004448 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
4449 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004450
4451
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004452reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4453reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004454 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
4455 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4456 no | yes | yes | yes
4457 Arguments :
4458 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4459 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4460 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4461 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4462 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
4463 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
4464
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004465 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4466 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4467
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004468 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
4469 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
4470 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
4471 next servers.
4472
4473 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4474 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4475 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4476
4477 Example :
4478 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
4479 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
4480 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
4481
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004482 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4483 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004484
4485
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004486reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4487reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004488 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4489 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4490 no | yes | yes | yes
4491 Arguments :
4492 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4493 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4494 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4495 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4496 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4497 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
4498 case.
4499
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004500 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4501 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4502
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004503 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4504 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
4505 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4506 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004507 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004508
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004509 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004510 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004511 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004512
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004513 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4514 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4515
4516 Example :
4517 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
4518 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4519 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4520
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004521 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4522 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004523
4524
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004525reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4526reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004527 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
4528 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4529 no | yes | yes | yes
4530 Arguments :
4531 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4532 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4533 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4534 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4535 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4536 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
4537 case.
4538
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004539 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4540 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4541
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004542 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4543 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
4544 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
4545 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4546
4547 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4548 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4549
4550 Example :
4551 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
4552 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
4553 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4554 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4555
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004556 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4557 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004558
4559
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004560reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4561reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004562 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
4563 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4564 no | yes | yes | yes
4565 Arguments :
4566 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4567 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4568 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4569 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4570 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
4571 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
4572
4573 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4574 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4575 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4576 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004577 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004578
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004579 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4580 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4581
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004582 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
4583 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
4584 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
4585
4586 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4587 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4588 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4589 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
4590 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4591
4592 Example :
4593 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
4594 reqrep ^([^\ ]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
4595 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
4596 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
4597
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004598 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", section 6 about HTTP header
4599 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004600
4601
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004602reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4603reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004604 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
4605 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4606 no | yes | yes | yes
4607 Arguments :
4608 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4609 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4610 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4611 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4612 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4613 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
4614 ignores case.
4615
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004616 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4617 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4618
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004619 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4620 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004621 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
4622 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
4623 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004624 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
4625 not set.
4626
4627 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
4628 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
4629 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
4630 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
4631 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
4632
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004633 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004634 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
4635 # block all others.
4636 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
4637 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
4638
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004639 # block bad guys
4640 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
4641 reqitarpit . if badguys
4642
4643 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
4644 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004645
4646
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02004647retries <value>
4648 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
4649 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4650 yes | no | yes | yes
4651 Arguments :
4652 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
4653 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
4654 default value is 3.
4655
4656 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
4657 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
4658 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
4659
4660 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
4661 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
4662
4663 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
4664 server even if a cookie references a different server.
4665
4666 See also : "option redispatch"
4667
4668
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004669rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004670 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
4671 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4672 no | yes | yes | yes
4673 Arguments :
4674 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4675 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004676 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004677
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004678 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4679 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4680
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004681 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4682 the last header of an HTTP response.
4683
4684 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4685 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4686 responses.
4687
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004688 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4689 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004690
4691
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004692rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4693rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004694 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
4695 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4696 no | yes | yes | yes
4697 Arguments :
4698 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4699 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4700 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4701 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4702 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4703 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
4704 ignores case.
4705
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004706 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4707 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4708
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004709 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
4710 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02004711 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004712 client.
4713
4714 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4715 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4716 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4717
4718 Example :
4719 # remove the Server header from responses
4720 reqidel ^Server:.*
4721
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004722 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4723 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004724
4725
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004726rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4727rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004728 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
4729 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4730 no | yes | yes | yes
4731 Arguments :
4732 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4733 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4734 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4735 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4736 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4737 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
4738 ignores case.
4739
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004740 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4741 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4742
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004743 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4744 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
4745 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
4746 case-sensitive.
4747
4748 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004749 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
4750 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
4751 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004752
4753 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4754 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
4755
4756 Example :
4757 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
4758 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
4759
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004760 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
4761 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004762
4763
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004764rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4765rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004766 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
4767 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4768 no | yes | yes | yes
4769 Arguments :
4770 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4771 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4772 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4773 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4774 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4775 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
4776 ignores case.
4777
4778 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4779 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4780 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4781 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004782 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004783
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004784 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4785 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4786
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004787 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
4788 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
4789 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
4790
4791 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4792 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4793 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4794 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
4795 are not case-sensitive.
4796
4797 Example :
4798 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
4799 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
4800
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004801 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
4802 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004803
4804
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01004805server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004806 Declare a server in a backend
4807 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4808 no | no | yes | yes
4809 Arguments :
4810 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004811 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-server-name" is
4812 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004813
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01004814 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
4815 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4816 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
4817 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02004818 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
4819 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
4820 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
4821 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
4822 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
4823 to report statistics.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004824
4825 <ports> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
4826 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
4827 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
4828 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
4829 adding this value to the client's port.
4830
4831 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
4832 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004833 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004834
4835 Examples :
4836 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
4837 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
4838
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004839 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
4840 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004841
4842
4843source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004844source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004845source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004846 Set the source address for outgoing connections
4847 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4848 yes | no | yes | yes
4849 Arguments :
4850 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
4851 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
4852 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
4853 the most appropriate address to reach its destination.
4854
4855 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
4856 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02004857 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
4858 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
4859 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004860
4861 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
4862 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
4863 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
4864 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
4865 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
4866 <addr>.
4867
4868 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
4869 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
4870 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
4871 port.
4872
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004873 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
4874 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
4875 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
4876 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
4877 and to automatically bind to the the client's IP address as seen
4878 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
4879 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
4880 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
4881 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
4882 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
4883 HTTP header.
4884
4885 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
4886 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
4887 in order to specificy which occurrence to use for the source IP
4888 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
4889 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
4890 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
4891 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
4892 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
4893 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
4894 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
4895
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004896 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
4897 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
4898 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
4899 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
4900 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
4901 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
4902
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004903 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
4904 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
4905 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
4906 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
4907
4908 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
4909 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
4910 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
4911 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
4912 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
4913 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
4914
4915 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
4916 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
4917 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
4918 there are two methods :
4919
4920 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
4921 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
4922 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
4923 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
4924 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
4925 of the client ranges may be used.
4926
4927 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
4928 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
4929 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
4930 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
4931 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
4932 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
4933 same session.
4934
4935 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
4936 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
4937 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
4938 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
4939 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
4940 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
4941
4942 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
4943 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
4944 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004945 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004946
4947 Examples :
4948 backend private
4949 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
4950 source 192.168.1.200
4951
4952 backend transparent_ssl1
4953 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
4954 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
4955
4956 backend transparent_ssl2
4957 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
4958 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
4959 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
4960
4961 backend transparent_ssl3
4962 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
4963 # is more conntrack-friendly.
4964 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
4965
4966 backend transparent_smtp
4967 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
4968 # with Tproxy version 4.
4969 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
4970
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004971 backend transparent_http
4972 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
4973 # proxy.
4974 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
4975
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004976 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004977 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
4978
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004979
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004980srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
4981 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
4982 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4983 yes | no | yes | yes
4984 Arguments :
4985 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
4986 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
4987 as explained at the top of this document.
4988
4989 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
4990 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
4991 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
4992 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
4993 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
4994 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
4995 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
4996
4997 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
4998 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
4999 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
5000 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
5001 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005002 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005003 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005004 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005005
5006 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
5007 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
5008 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
5009 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
5010 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
5011 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
5012
5013 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
5014 Please use "timeout server" instead.
5015
5016 See also : "timeout server", "timeout client" and "clitimeout".
5017
5018
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005019stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
5020 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
5021 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5022 no | no | yes | yes
5023
5024 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
5025 matched.
5026
5027 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
5028 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
5029
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005030 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5031 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5032 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5033
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01005034 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
5035 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
5036 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
5037 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005038
5039 Example :
5040 # statistics admin level only for localhost
5041 backend stats_localhost
5042 stats enable
5043 stats admin if LOCALHOST
5044
5045 Example :
5046 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
5047 backend stats_auth
5048 stats enable
5049 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
5050 stats admin if TRUE
5051
5052 Example :
5053 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
5054 userlist stats-auth
5055 group admin users admin
5056 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
5057 group readonly users haproxy
5058 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
5059
5060 backend stats_auth
5061 stats enable
5062 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
5063 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
5064 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
5065 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
5066
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005067 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
5068 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5069 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005070
5071
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005072stats auth <user>:<passwd>
5073 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
5074 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5075 yes | no | yes | yes
5076 Arguments :
5077 <user> is a user name to grant access to
5078
5079 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
5080
5081 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
5082 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
5083 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
5084 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
5085 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
5086 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
5087
5088 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
5089 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
5090 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005091 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005092
5093 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
5094 report using "stats scope".
5095
5096 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5097 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5098 unobvious parameters.
5099
5100 Example :
5101 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5102 backend public_www
5103 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5104 stats enable
5105 stats hide-version
5106 stats scope .
5107 stats uri /admin?stats
5108 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5109 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5110 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5111
5112 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5113 backend private_monitoring
5114 stats enable
5115 stats uri /admin?stats
5116 stats refresh 5s
5117
5118 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
5119
5120
5121stats enable
5122 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
5123 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5124 yes | no | yes | yes
5125 Arguments : none
5126
5127 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
5128 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
5129 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
5130 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
5131 - stats auth : no authentication
5132 - stats scope : no restriction
5133
5134 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5135 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5136 unobvious parameters.
5137
5138 Example :
5139 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5140 backend public_www
5141 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5142 stats enable
5143 stats hide-version
5144 stats scope .
5145 stats uri /admin?stats
5146 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5147 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5148 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5149
5150 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5151 backend private_monitoring
5152 stats enable
5153 stats uri /admin?stats
5154 stats refresh 5s
5155
5156 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5157
5158
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005159stats hide-version
5160 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005161 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5162 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005163 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005164
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005165 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
5166 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
5167 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
5168 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
5169 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
5170 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005171
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005172 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5173 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5174 unobvious parameters.
5175
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005176 Example :
5177 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5178 backend public_www
5179 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005180 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005181 stats hide-version
5182 stats scope .
5183 stats uri /admin?stats
5184 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5185 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5186 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005187
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005188 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5189 backend private_monitoring
5190 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005191 stats uri /admin?stats
5192 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01005193
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005194 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005195
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005196
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02005197stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
5198 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5199 Access control for statistics
5200
5201 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5202 no | no | yes | yes
5203
5204 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
5205 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
5206 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
5207 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
5208 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
5209 should be asked to enter a username and password.
5210
5211 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
5212 instance.
5213
5214 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5215 about ACL usage.
5216
5217
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005218stats realm <realm>
5219 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
5220 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5221 yes | no | yes | yes
5222 Arguments :
5223 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
5224 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
5225 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
5226
5227 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
5228 using a backslash ('\').
5229
5230 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
5231 only related to authentication.
5232
5233 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5234 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5235 unobvious parameters.
5236
5237 Example :
5238 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5239 backend public_www
5240 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5241 stats enable
5242 stats hide-version
5243 stats scope .
5244 stats uri /admin?stats
5245 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5246 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5247 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5248
5249 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5250 backend private_monitoring
5251 stats enable
5252 stats uri /admin?stats
5253 stats refresh 5s
5254
5255 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
5256
5257
5258stats refresh <delay>
5259 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
5260 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5261 yes | no | yes | yes
5262 Arguments :
5263 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
5264 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
5265 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
5266 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
5267 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
5268 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
5269
5270 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
5271 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
5272 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
5273 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
5274
5275 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5276 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5277 unobvious parameters.
5278
5279 Example :
5280 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5281 backend public_www
5282 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5283 stats enable
5284 stats hide-version
5285 stats scope .
5286 stats uri /admin?stats
5287 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5288 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5289 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5290
5291 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5292 backend private_monitoring
5293 stats enable
5294 stats uri /admin?stats
5295 stats refresh 5s
5296
5297 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5298
5299
5300stats scope { <name> | "." }
5301 Enable statistics and limit access scope
5302 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5303 yes | no | yes | yes
5304 Arguments :
5305 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
5306 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
5307 section in which the statement appears.
5308
5309 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
5310 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
5311 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
5312 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
5313 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
5314 exists.
5315
5316 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5317 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5318 unobvious parameters.
5319
5320 Example :
5321 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5322 backend public_www
5323 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5324 stats enable
5325 stats hide-version
5326 stats scope .
5327 stats uri /admin?stats
5328 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5329 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5330 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5331
5332 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5333 backend private_monitoring
5334 stats enable
5335 stats uri /admin?stats
5336 stats refresh 5s
5337
5338 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5339
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005340
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005341stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005342 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
5343 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5344 yes | no | yes | yes
5345
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005346 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005347 description from global section is automatically used instead.
5348
5349 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5350 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
5351
5352 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5353 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5354 unobvious parameters.
5355
5356 Example :
5357 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5358 backend private_monitoring
5359 stats enable
5360 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
5361 stats uri /admin?stats
5362 stats refresh 5s
5363
5364 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
5365 global section.
5366
5367
5368stats show-legends
5369 Enable reporting additional informations on the statistics page :
5370 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
5371 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
5372 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
5373 - IP (socket, server)
5374 - cookie (backend, server)
5375
5376 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5377 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5378 unobvious parameters.
5379
5380 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
5381
5382
5383stats show-node [ <name> ]
5384 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
5385 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5386 yes | no | yes | yes
5387 Arguments:
5388 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
5389 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
5390
5391 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5392 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
5393 provided for each customer.
5394
5395 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5396 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5397 unobvious parameters.
5398
5399 Example:
5400 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5401 backend private_monitoring
5402 stats enable
5403 stats show-node Europe-1
5404 stats uri /admin?stats
5405 stats refresh 5s
5406
5407 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
5408 section.
5409
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005410
5411stats uri <prefix>
5412 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
5413 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5414 yes | no | yes | yes
5415 Arguments :
5416 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
5417 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
5418 query string.
5419
5420 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
5421 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
5422 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
5423 possible to reach it in the application.
5424
5425 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005426 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005427 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
5428 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
5429 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
5430 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
5431
5432 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
5433 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
5434 an address or a port to statistics only.
5435
5436 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5437 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5438 unobvious parameters.
5439
5440 Example :
5441 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5442 backend public_www
5443 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5444 stats enable
5445 stats hide-version
5446 stats scope .
5447 stats uri /admin?stats
5448 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5449 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5450 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5451
5452 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5453 backend private_monitoring
5454 stats enable
5455 stats uri /admin?stats
5456 stats refresh 5s
5457
5458 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
5459
5460
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005461stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
5462 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005463 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005464 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005465
5466 Arguments :
5467 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5468 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5469 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
5470 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
5471
5472 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5473 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5474 the "stick-table" statement.
5475
5476 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
5477 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
5478 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
5479 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
5480 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
5481
5482 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5483 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
5484 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
5485 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
5486 transformation rules.
5487
5488 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5489 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5490 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5491 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5492 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5493 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5494 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5495
5496 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
5497 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
5498 ACL based conditions.
5499
5500 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
5501 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
5502 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
5503 matches can be used as fallbacks.
5504
5505 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
5506 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
5507 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
5508 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
5509
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005510 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5511 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5512 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5513
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005514 Example :
5515 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5516 # last 30 minutes
5517 backend pop
5518 mode tcp
5519 balance roundrobin
5520 stick store-request src
5521 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5522 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5523 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5524
5525 backend smtp
5526 mode tcp
5527 balance roundrobin
5528 stick match src table pop
5529 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5530 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5531
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005532 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5533 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005534
5535
5536stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5537 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
5538 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5539 no | no | yes | yes
5540
5541 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
5542 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
5543 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
5544 for writing more maintainable configurations.
5545
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005546 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5547 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5548 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5549
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005550 Examples :
5551 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01005552 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005553
5554 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
5555 stick match src table pop if !localhost
5556 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
5557
5558
5559 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
5560 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
5561 backend http
5562 mode http
5563 balance roundrobin
5564 stick on src table https
5565 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
5566 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
5567 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
5568
5569 backend https
5570 mode tcp
5571 balance roundrobin
5572 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5573 stick on src
5574 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
5575 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
5576
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005577 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005578
5579
5580stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5581 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5582 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5583 no | no | yes | yes
5584
5585 Arguments :
5586 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5587 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5588 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5589 server is selected.
5590
5591 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5592 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5593 the "stick-table" statement.
5594
5595 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5596 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5597 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
5598 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
5599 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
5600 address.
5601
5602 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5603 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
5604 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
5605 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
5606 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
5607 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
5608 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
5609 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
5610 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
5611 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
5612
5613 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5614 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5615 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5616 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5617 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5618 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5619 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5620
5621 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
5622 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5623 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
5624 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5625
5626 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
5627 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5628 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5629 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5630 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5631 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5632 another protocol or access method.
5633
5634 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
5635 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
5636 the request.
5637
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005638 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5639 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5640 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5641
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005642 Example :
5643 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5644 # last 30 minutes
5645 backend pop
5646 mode tcp
5647 balance roundrobin
5648 stick store-request src
5649 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5650 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5651 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5652
5653 backend smtp
5654 mode tcp
5655 balance roundrobin
5656 stick match src table pop
5657 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5658 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5659
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005660 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5661 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005662
5663
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005664stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005665 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
5666 [store <data_type>]*
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005667 Configure the stickiness table for the current backend
5668 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005669 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005670
5671 Arguments :
5672 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
5673 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
5674 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5675 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5676
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01005677 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
5678 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
5679 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5680 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5681
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005682 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
5683 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
5684 instance.
5685
5686 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
5687 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
5688 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5689 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
5690 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
5691 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005692 to 32 characters.
5693
5694 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
5695 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
5696 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5697 being stored. If the block provided by the pattern extractor
5698 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
5699 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005700
5701 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005702 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
5703 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005704 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
5705 increase.
5706
5707 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005708 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
5709 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
5710 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005711
5712 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
5713 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
5714 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
5715 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
5716 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
5717 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
5718 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
5719 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
5720 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
5721 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
5722 parameter (see below).
5723
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005724 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
5725 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
5726 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
5727 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
5728 soft restart.
5729
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005730 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
5731
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005732 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
5733 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
5734 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
5735 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
5736 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
5737 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
5738 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
5739 if not expiration delay is specified.
5740
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005741 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
5742 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
5743 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
5744 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005745 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
5746 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
5747 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
5748 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
5749 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
5750 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
5751 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
5752 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
5753 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
5754 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
5755 types and their arguments.
5756
5757 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
5758 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
5759 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
5760 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
5761
5762 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
5763 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
5764 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
5765 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
5766
5767 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5768 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
5769 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
5770 they were received.
5771
5772 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5773 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
5774 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
5775 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
5776 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
5777
5778 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5779 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5780 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5781 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
5782 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5783
5784 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5785 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
5786 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
5787
5788 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5789 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5790 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5791 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
5792 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5793
5794 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5795 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
5796 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
5797 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
5798 the client side.
5799
5800 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5801 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5802 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5803 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
5804 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
5805 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
5806 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
5807
5808 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5809 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
5810 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
5811 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
5812 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
5813 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
5814 (eg: vulnerability scan).
5815
5816 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5817 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5818 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5819 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
5820 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
5821 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5822
5823 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5824 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
5825 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
5826 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
5827
5828 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5829 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5830 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5831 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5832 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5833 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
5834 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
5835 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
5836 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
5837 recommended for better fairness.
5838
5839 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5840 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
5841 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
5842 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
5843
5844 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
5845 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5846 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5847 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5848 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5849 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
5850 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
5851 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
5852 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
5853 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005854
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005855 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
5856 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005857 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
5858 reference it.
5859
5860 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
5861 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
5862 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
5863 as an exclusive stickiness.
5864
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005865 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
5866 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
5867 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
5868 something that can be ignored.
5869
5870 Example:
5871 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
5872 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
5873 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
5874 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
5875
5876 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01005877 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005878
5879
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005880stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5881 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5882 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5883 no | no | yes | yes
5884
5885 Arguments :
5886 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5887 describes what elements of the response or connection will
5888 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5889 server is selected.
5890
5891 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5892 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5893 the "stick-table" statement.
5894
5895 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5896 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5897 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
5898 when the response is a SSL server hello.
5899
5900 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5901 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
5902 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
5903 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
5904 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
5905 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
5906 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
5907 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
5908 rules.
5909
5910 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5911 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5912 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5913 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5914 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5915 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5916 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5917
5918 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
5919 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5920 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
5921 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5922
5923 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
5924 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5925 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5926 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5927 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5928 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5929 another protocol or access method.
5930
5931 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
5932
5933 Example :
5934 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
5935 backend https
5936 mode tcp
5937 balance roundrobin
5938 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
5939 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
5940
5941 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
5942 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
5943
5944 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
5945 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
5946 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
5947
5948 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
5949 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
5950
5951 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
5952 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
5953 # at offset 44.
5954
5955 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
5956 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
5957
5958 # Learn on response if server hello.
5959 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
5960
5961 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
5962 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
5963
5964 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
5965 extraction.
5966
5967
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005968tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5969 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02005970 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5971 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005972 Arguments :
5973 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
5974 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
5975 See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02005976
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005977 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005978
5979 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
5980 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005981 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
5982 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
5983 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
5984 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
5985 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
5986 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005987
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005988 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
5989 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
5990 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
5991 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005992
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005993 Three types of actions are supported :
5994 - accept :
5995 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
5996 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
5997 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005998
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005999 - reject :
6000 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6001 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6002 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
6003 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
6004 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
6005 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
6006 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
6007 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
6008 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
6009 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
6010 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
6011 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006012
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006013 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
6014 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
6015 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
6016 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
6017 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
6018 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
6019 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
6020 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
6021 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006022
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006023 These actions take one or two arguments :
6024 <key> is mandatory, and defines the criterion the tracking key will
6025 be derived from. At the moment, only "src" is supported. With
6026 it, the key will be the connection's source IPv4 address.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006027
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006028 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
6029 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
6030 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
6031 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006032
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006033 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
6034 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
6035 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
6036 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
6037 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
6038 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
6039 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
6040 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
6041 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
6042 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006043
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006044 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6045 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6046 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006047
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006048 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
6049 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
6050 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006051
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006052 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006053 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006054 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006055
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006056 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
6057 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
6058 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006059
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006060 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
6061 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
6062 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006063
6064 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6065
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006066 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006067
6068
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006069tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6070 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006071 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006072 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006073 Arguments :
6074 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6075 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
6076 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006077
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006078 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006079
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006080 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
6081 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6082 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
6083 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
6084 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006085
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006086 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
6087 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
6088 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
6089 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
6090 both frontends and backends. In frontends, they will be evaluated upon new
6091 connections. In backends, they will be evaluated once a session is assigned
6092 a backend. This means that a single frontend connection may be evaluated
6093 several times by one or multiple backends when a session gets reassigned
6094 (for instance after a client-side HTTP keep-alive request).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006095
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006096 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6097 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6098 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6099 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006100
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006101 Three types of actions are supported :
6102 - accept :
6103 - reject :
6104 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006105
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006106 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
6107 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006108
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006109 Also, it is worth noting that if sticky counters are tracked from a rule
6110 defined in a backend, this tracking will automatically end when the session
6111 releases the backend. That allows per-backend counter tracking even in case
6112 of HTTP keep-alive requests when the backend changes. While there is nothing
6113 mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the track-sc1 pointer to track
6114 per-frontend counters and track-sc2 to track per-backend counters.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006115
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006116 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006117 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6118 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006119
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006120 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
6121 rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full request has been
6122 buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this, the
6123 best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
6124 period.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006125
6126 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006127 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
6128 # and reject everything else.
6129 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
6130 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6131 tcp-request content accept if HTTP is_host_com
6132 tcp-request content reject
6133
6134 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006135 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
6136 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6137 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006138 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006139
6140 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
6141 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6142 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006143 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006144 tcp-request content reject
6145
6146 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
6147 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
6148
6149 frontend http
6150 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC1 as a global abuse counter
6151 # protecting all our sites
6152 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
6153 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
6154 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
6155 ...
6156 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
6157
6158 backend http_dynamic
6159 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
6160 # by SC2), block it globally in the frontend.
6161 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
6162 acl click_too_fast sc2_http_req_rate gt 10
6163 acl mark_as_abuser sc1_inc_gpc0
6164 tcp-request content track-sc2 src
6165 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006166
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006167 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006168
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006169 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006170
6171
6172tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
6173 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
6174 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006175 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006176 Arguments :
6177 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6178 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6179 as explained at the top of this document.
6180
6181 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
6182 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
6183 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
6184 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
6185 data for at most the specified amount of time.
6186
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006187 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
6188 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
6189 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
6190 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
6191
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006192 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
6193 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006194 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006195 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01006196 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
6197 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
6198 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
6199 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006200
6201 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
6202 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
6203 it pass through unaffected.
6204
6205 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
6206 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
6207 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006208 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006209 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
6210 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02006211 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
6212 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
6213 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006214
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006215 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006216 "timeout client".
6217
6218
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006219tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6220 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
6221 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6222 no | no | yes | yes
6223 Arguments :
6224 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6225 actions include : "accept", "reject".
6226 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
6227
6228 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
6229
6230 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
6231 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6232 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
6233 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection delay is
6234 set and expires with no matching rule.
6235
6236 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
6237
6238 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6239 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6240 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6241 inserted.
6242
6243 Two types of actions are supported :
6244 - accept :
6245 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6246 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6247 the rules evaluation.
6248
6249 - reject :
6250 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6251 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6252 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediatly closed.
6253
6254 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6255 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6256 for changing the default action to a reject.
6257
6258 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-reponse content"
6259 rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has been
6260 buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this, the
6261 best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
6262 period.
6263
6264 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6265
6266 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
6267
6268
6269tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
6270 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
6271 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6272 no | no | yes | yes
6273 Arguments :
6274 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6275 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6276 as explained at the top of this document.
6277
6278 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
6279
6280
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006281timeout check <timeout>
6282 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
6283 established.
6284
6285 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6286 yes | no | yes | yes
6287 Arguments:
6288 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6289 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6290 as explained at the top of this document.
6291
6292 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
6293 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
6294 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
6295 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01006296 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
6297 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
6298 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006299
6300 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
6301 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
6302
6303 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
6304 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006305 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006306
6307 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6308 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6309 forget about it.
6310
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006311 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
6312 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006313
6314
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006315timeout client <timeout>
6316timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6317 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
6318 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6319 yes | yes | yes | no
6320 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006321 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006322 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6323 as explained at the top of this document.
6324
6325 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
6326 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6327 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
6328 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
6329 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
6330 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
6331 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
6332 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006333 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006334 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
6335 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
6336
6337 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
6338 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6339 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6340 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6341 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6342 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6343
6344 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
6345 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
6346 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6347
6348 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server".
6349
6350
6351timeout connect <timeout>
6352timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6353 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
6354 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6355 yes | no | yes | yes
6356 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006357 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006358 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6359 as explained at the top of this document.
6360
6361 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006362 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006363 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006364 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006365 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
6366 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006367
6368 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6369 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6370 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6371 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6372 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
6373 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6374
6375 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
6376 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
6377 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6378
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006379 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
6380 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006381
6382
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006383timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
6384 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
6385 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6386 yes | yes | yes | yes
6387 Arguments :
6388 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6389 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6390 as explained at the top of this document.
6391
6392 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
6393 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
6394 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
6395 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
6396 once the request has started to present itself.
6397
6398 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
6399 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
6400 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
6401 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
6402 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
6403
6404 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
6405 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
6406 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
6407 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
6408
6409 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
6410 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
6411 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
6412 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
6413 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02006414 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006415
6416 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
6417 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
6418 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
6419 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
6420
6421 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
6422
6423
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006424timeout http-request <timeout>
6425 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
6426 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006427 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006428 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006429 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006430 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6431 as explained at the top of this document.
6432
6433 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
6434 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
6435 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
6436 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
6437 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
6438 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
6439 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
6440 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time.
6441
6442 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
6443 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006444 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
6445 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006446
6447 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
6448 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
6449 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
6450 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
6451 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
6452
6453 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006454 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
6455 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
6456 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006457
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006458 See also : "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006459
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006460
6461timeout queue <timeout>
6462 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
6463 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6464 yes | no | yes | yes
6465 Arguments :
6466 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6467 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6468 as explained at the top of this document.
6469
6470 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
6471 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
6472 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
6473 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
6474 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
6475
6476 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
6477 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
6478 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
6479 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
6480
6481 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6482
6483
6484timeout server <timeout>
6485timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6486 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6487 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6488 yes | no | yes | yes
6489 Arguments :
6490 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6491 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6492 as explained at the top of this document.
6493
6494 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6495 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6496 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6497 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6498 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6499 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6500 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6501
6502 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6503 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6504 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6505 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6506 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006507 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006508 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006509 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006510
6511 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6512 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6513 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6514 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6515 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6516 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6517
6518 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
6519 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
6520 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6521
6522 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client".
6523
6524
6525timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006526 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006527 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6528 yes | yes | yes | yes
6529 Arguments :
6530 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
6531 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6532 as explained at the top of this document.
6533
6534 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
6535 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
6536 defines how long it will be maintained open.
6537
6538 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6539 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6540 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
6541 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006542 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006543
6544 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6545
6546
6547transparent (deprecated)
6548 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6549 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006550 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006551 Arguments : none
6552
6553 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
6554 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6555 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6556 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6557 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6558 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6559 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6560 appropriate server.
6561
6562 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
6563
6564 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6565 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6566
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006567 See also: "option transparent"
6568
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006569unique-id-format <string>
6570 Generate a unique ID for each request.
6571 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6572 yes | yes | yes | no
6573 Arguments :
6574 <string> is a log-format string.
6575
6576 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
6577 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
6578 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
6579 %ID tag the log-format string.
6580
6581 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
6582 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
6583 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
6584 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
6585 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
6586 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
6587 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
6588 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
6589
6590 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
6591 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
6592
6593 Example:
6594
6595 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
6596
6597 will generate:
6598
6599 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
6600
6601 See also: "unique-id-header"
6602
6603unique-id-header <name>
6604 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
6605 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6606 yes | yes | yes | no
6607 Arguments :
6608 <name> is the name of the header.
6609
6610 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
6611 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
6612
6613 Example:
6614
6615 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
6616 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
6617
6618 will generate:
6619
6620 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
6621
6622 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006623
6624use_backend <backend> if <condition>
6625use_backend <backend> unless <condition>
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006626 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006627 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6628 no | yes | yes | no
6629 Arguments :
6630 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section.
6631
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006632 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006633
6634 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
6635 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
6636 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006637 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
6638 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
6639 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
6640 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006641
6642 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
6643 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
6644 assign the backend.
6645
6646 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
6647 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
6648 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
6649 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
6650 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
6651 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
6652
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006653 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006654 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006655 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
6656 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
6657 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
6658
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006659 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006660
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006661
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02006662use-server <server> if <condition>
6663use-server <server> unless <condition>
6664 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
6665 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6666 no | no | yes | yes
6667 Arguments :
6668 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
6669
6670 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
6671
6672 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
6673 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
6674 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
6675
6676 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
6677 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
6678 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
6679 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
6680 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
6681 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
6682 matches will assign the server.
6683
6684 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
6685 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
6686 with the next rules until one matches.
6687
6688 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
6689 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
6690 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
6691 according to other persistence mechanisms.
6692
6693 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
6694 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
6695 stripped.
6696
6697 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
6698 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
6699 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
6700 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
6701
6702 Example :
6703 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
6704 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
6705 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
6706 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
6707 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
6708 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
6709 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
6710 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
6711 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
6712
6713 See also: "use_backend", serction 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
6714
6715
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010067165. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006717------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006718
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01006719The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
6720which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
6721arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
6722settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
6723after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
6724Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
6725address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006726
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006727 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01006728 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006729
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006730The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006731
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006732addr <ipv4>
6733 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
6734 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
6735 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
6736 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
6737 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006738
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006739 Supported in default-server: No
6740
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006741backup
6742 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
6743 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
6744 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
6745 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
6746 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
6747 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006748
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006749 Supported in default-server: No
6750
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006751check
6752 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01006753 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
6754 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
6755 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
6756 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
6757 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
6758 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
6759 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
6760 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
6761 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
6762 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006763
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006764 Supported in default-server: No
6765
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006766cookie <value>
6767 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
6768 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
6769 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
6770 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
6771 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
6772 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
6773 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
6774
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006775 Supported in default-server: No
6776
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02006777disabled
6778 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
6779 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
6780 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
6781 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
6782 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
6783
6784 Supported in default-server: No
6785
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006786error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01006787 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
6788 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
6789 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006790
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006791 Supported in default-server: Yes
6792
6793 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006794
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006795fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006796 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
6797 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
6798 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
6799
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006800 Supported in default-server: Yes
6801
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006802id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02006803 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
6804 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
6805 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006806
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006807 Supported in default-server: No
6808
6809inter <delay>
6810fastinter <delay>
6811downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006812 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
6813 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
6814 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
6815 between checks depending on the server state :
6816
6817 Server state | Interval used
6818 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6819 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
6820 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6821 Transitionally UP (going down), |
6822 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
6823 or yet unchecked. |
6824 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6825 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
6826 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006827
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006828 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
6829 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
6830 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
6831 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
6832 hosted on the same hardware, the health-checks of all servers are started
6833 with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to add some random
6834 noise in the health checks interval using the global "spread-checks"
6835 keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot of backends use the same
6836 servers.
6837
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006838 Supported in default-server: Yes
6839
6840maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006841 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
6842 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
6843 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
6844 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
6845 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
6846 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
6847 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
6848 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
6849
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006850 Supported in default-server: Yes
6851
6852maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006853 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
6854 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
6855 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
6856 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
6857 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
6858 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
6859 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
6860
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006861 Supported in default-server: Yes
6862
6863minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006864 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
6865 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
6866 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
6867 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
6868 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
6869 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006870 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006871 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006872
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006873 Supported in default-server: Yes
6874
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09006875non-stick
6876 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
6877 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
6878 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
6879
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006880observe <mode>
6881 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
6882 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
6883 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
6884 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
6885 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
6886 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01006887 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006888
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006889 Supported in default-server: No
6890
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006891 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
6892
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006893on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006894 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
6895 Currently, four modes are available:
6896 - fastinter: force fastinter
6897 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
6898 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
6899 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
6900 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
6901
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006902 Supported in default-server: Yes
6903
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006904 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
6905
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09006906on-marked-down <action>
6907 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
6908 Currently one action is available:
6909 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions
6910
6911 Actions are disabled by default
6912
6913 Supported in default-server: Yes
6914
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006915port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006916 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
6917 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
6918 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
6919 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
6920 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
6921 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
6922
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006923 Supported in default-server: Yes
6924
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006925redir <prefix>
6926 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
6927 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
6928 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
6929 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
6930 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
6931 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
6932 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
6933 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006934 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006935 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
6936 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
6937 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
6938 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
6939 loop between the client and HAProxy!
6940
6941 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
6942
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006943 Supported in default-server: No
6944
6945rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006946 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
6947 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
6948 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
6949
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006950 Supported in default-server: Yes
6951
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01006952send-proxy
6953 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
6954 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
6955 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
6956 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
6957 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
6958 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
6959 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
6960 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
6961 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
6962 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. See also the "accept-proxy"
6963 option of the "bind" keyword.
6964
6965 Supported in default-server: No
6966
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006967slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006968 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
6969 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
6970 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
6971 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
6972 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
6973 parameters :
6974
6975 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
6976 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
6977
6978 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
6979 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
6980 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
6981 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
6982
6983 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
6984 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
6985 seen as failed.
6986
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006987 Supported in default-server: Yes
6988
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006989source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006990source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006991source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006992 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
6993 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
6994 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
6995 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
6996
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006997 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
6998 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
6999 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
7000 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
7001 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
7002 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
7003 server.
7004
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007005 Supported in default-server: No
7006
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007007track [<proxy>/]<server>
7008 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by
7009 tracking another one. Only a server with checks enabled can be tracked
7010 so it is not possible for example to track a server that tracks another
7011 one. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
7012 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
7013
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007014 Supported in default-server: No
7015
7016weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007017 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
7018 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
7019 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02007020 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
7021 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
7022 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
7023 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
7024 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
7025 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007026
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007027 Supported in default-server: Yes
7028
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007029
70306. HTTP header manipulation
7031---------------------------
7032
7033In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
7034response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
7035request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
7036which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
7037against information leak from the internal network. But there is a limitation
7038to this : since HAProxy's HTTP engine does not support keep-alive, only headers
7039passed during the first request of a TCP session will be seen. All subsequent
7040headers will be considered data only and not analyzed. Furthermore, HAProxy
7041never touches data contents, it stops analysis at the end of headers.
7042
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02007043There is an exception though. If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response"
7044(status code 1xx), it is able to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny,
7045rewrite or delete a header, but it will refuse to add a header to any such
7046messages as this is not HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers
7047in such responses is to stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007048happen, for instance because another downstream equipment would unconditionally
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02007049add a header, or if a server name appears there. When such messages are seen,
7050normal processing still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
7051
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007052This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
7053in section 4.2 :
7054
7055 - reqadd <string>
7056 - reqallow <search>
7057 - reqiallow <search>
7058 - reqdel <search>
7059 - reqidel <search>
7060 - reqdeny <search>
7061 - reqideny <search>
7062 - reqpass <search>
7063 - reqipass <search>
7064 - reqrep <search> <replace>
7065 - reqirep <search> <replace>
7066 - reqtarpit <search>
7067 - reqitarpit <search>
7068 - rspadd <string>
7069 - rspdel <search>
7070 - rspidel <search>
7071 - rspdeny <search>
7072 - rspideny <search>
7073 - rsprep <search> <replace>
7074 - rspirep <search> <replace>
7075
7076With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
7077is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
7078parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
7079prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
7080Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
7081
7082 \t for a tab
7083 \r for a carriage return (CR)
7084 \n for a new line (LF)
7085 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
7086 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
7087 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
7088 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
7089 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
7090
7091The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
7092portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
7093above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
7094regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
70959 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
7096is very common to users of the "sed" program.
7097
7098The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
7099after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
7100
7101Notes related to these keywords :
7102---------------------------------
7103 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
7104 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
7105 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
7106
7107 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
7108 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
7109 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
7110
7111 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
7112 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
7113 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
7114 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
7115 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
7116
7117 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
7118 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
7119 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
7120 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
7121 useless headers before adding new ones.
7122
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007123 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007124 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
7125
7126 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
7127 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
7128 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
7129
7130 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
7131 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007132 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007133
7134
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010071357. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
7136------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007137
7138The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
7139content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
7140from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
7141simple :
7142
7143 - define test criteria with sets of values
7144 - perform actions only if a set of tests is valid
7145
7146The actions generally consist in blocking the request, or selecting a backend.
7147
7148In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
7149
7150 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
7151
7152This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
7153Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
7154and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
7155an operator which may be specified before the set of values. The values are
7156of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
7157
7158ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
7159'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
7160which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
7161
7162There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
7163performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
7164
7165The following ACL flags are currently supported :
7166
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007167 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
7168 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007169 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
7170
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007171The "-f" flag is special as it loads all of the lines it finds in the file
7172specified in argument and loads all of them before continuing. It is even
7173possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments if the patterns are to be loaded from
Willy Tarreau58215a02010-05-13 22:07:43 +02007174multiple files. Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will
7175be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs will be stripped. If it is absolutely
7176needed to insert a valid pattern beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a
7177space so that it is not taken for a comment. Depending on the data type and
7178match method, haproxy may load the lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast
7179lookups. This is true for IPv4 and exact string matching. In this case,
7180duplicates will automatically be removed. Also, note that the "-i" flag applies
7181to subsequent entries and not to entries loaded from files preceeding it. For
7182instance :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007183
7184 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
7185
7186In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
7187the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
7188case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
7189too.
7190
7191Note that right now it is difficult for the ACL parsers to report errors, so if
7192a file is unreadable or unparsable, the most you'll get is a parse error in the
7193ACL. Thus, file-based ACLs should only be produced by reliable processes.
7194
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007195Supported types of values are :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007196
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007197 - integers or integer ranges
7198 - strings
7199 - regular expressions
7200 - IP addresses and networks
7201
7202
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020072037.1. Matching integers
7204----------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007205
7206Matching integers is special in that ranges and operators are permitted. Note
7207that integer matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value
7208expressed with a lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which
7209may be omitted.
7210
7211For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
7212unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
7213representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
7214
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007215As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
7216two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
7217instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
7218ranges and operators.
7219
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007220For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007221operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
7222Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
7223of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007224
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007225Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007226
7227 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
7228 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
7229 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
7230 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
7231 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
7232
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007233For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007234
7235 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
7236
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007237This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
7238
7239 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
7240
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007241
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020072427.2. Matching strings
7243---------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007244
7245String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
7246exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
7247characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
7248string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
7249to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007250before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007251
7252
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020072537.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
7254-------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007255
7256Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
7257they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
7258possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
7259passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
7260the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007261the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
7262match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007263
7264
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020072657.4. Matching IPv4 addresses
7266----------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007267
7268IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
7269netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
7270within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007271host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007272difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
7273at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
7274does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
7275parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007276
7277
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020072787.5. Available matching criteria
7279--------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007280
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020072817.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
7282------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007283
7284A first set of criteria applies to information which does not require any
7285analysis of the request or response contents. Those generally include TCP/IP
7286addresses and ports, as well as internal values independant on the stream.
7287
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007288always_false
7289 This one never matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
7290 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
7291
7292always_true
7293 This one always matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
7294 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
7295
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007296avg_queue <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007297avg_queue(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007298 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
7299 divided by the number of active servers. This is very similar to "queue"
7300 except that the size of the farm is considered, in order to give a more
7301 accurate measurement of the time it may take for a new connection to be
7302 processed. The main usage is to return a sorry page to new users when it
7303 becomes certain they will get a degraded service. Note that in the event
7304 there would not be any active server anymore, we would consider twice the
7305 number of queued connections as the measured value. This is a fair estimate,
7306 as we expect one server to get back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send
7307 new traffic to another backend if in better shape. See also the "queue",
7308 "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +01007309
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007310be_conn <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007311be_conn(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007312 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
7313 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
7314 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
7315 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
7316 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007317
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01007318be_id <integer>
7319 Applies to the backend's id. Can be used in frontends to check from which
7320 backend it was called.
7321
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007322be_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007323be_sess_rate(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007324 Returns true when the sessions creation rate on the backend matches the
7325 specified values or ranges, in number of new sessions per second. This is
7326 used to switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one
7327 reaches too high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent
7328 sucking of an online dictionary).
7329
7330 Example :
7331 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
7332 backend dynamic
7333 mode http
7334 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
7335 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007336
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007337connslots <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007338connslots(<backend>) <integer>
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007339 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007340 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007341 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
7342
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007343 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
7344 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007345
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007346 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007347 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
7348 multiple backends (perhaps using acls to do name-based load balancing) and
7349 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
7350 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
7351 actually *down*, this acl is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007352 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007353
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007354 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
7355 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
7356 then this acl clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
7357 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007358
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007359dst <ip_address>
7360 Applies to the local IPv4 address the client connected to. It can be used to
7361 switch to a different backend for some alternative addresses.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007362
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007363dst_conn <integer>
7364 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the same socket
7365 including the one being evaluated. It can be used to either return a sorry
7366 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
7367 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
7368 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
7369 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" criteria.
7370
7371dst_port <integer>
7372 Applies to the local port the client connected to. It can be used to switch
7373 to a different backend for some alternative ports.
7374
7375fe_conn <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007376fe_conn(<frontend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007377 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
7378 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
7379 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
7380 frontend. It can be used to either return a sorry page before hard-blocking,
7381 or to use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is
7382 considered saturated. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn" and "fe_sess_rate"
7383 criteria.
7384
7385fe_id <integer>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007386 Applies to the frontend's id. Can be used in backends to check from which
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007387 frontend it was called.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007388
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007389fe_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007390fe_sess_rate(<frontend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007391 Returns true when the session creation rate on the current or the named
7392 frontend matches the specified values or ranges, expressed in new sessions
7393 per second. This is used to limit the connection rate to acceptable ranges in
7394 order to prevent abuse of service at the earliest moment. This can be
7395 combined with layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for
7396 the rate to go down below the limit.
7397
7398 Example :
7399 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
7400 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
7401 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
7402 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
7403 frontend mail
7404 bind :25
7405 mode tcp
7406 maxconn 100
7407 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
7408 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
7409 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
7410 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007411
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007412nbsrv <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007413nbsrv(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007414 Returns true when the number of usable servers of either the current backend
7415 or the named backend matches the values or ranges specified. This is used to
7416 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
7417 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
7418 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007419
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007420queue <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007421queue(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007422 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
7423 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
7424 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
7425 one. This can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level,
7426 generally indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers.
7427 One possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones.
7428 See also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
7429
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007430sc1_bytes_in_rate
7431sc2_bytes_in_rate
7432 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
7433 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
7434 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
7435
7436sc1_bytes_out_rate
7437sc2_bytes_out_rate
7438 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
7439 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
7440 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
7441
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02007442sc1_clr_gpc0
7443sc2_clr_gpc0
7444 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
7445 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
7446 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. The test
7447 can also be used alone and always returns true. This is typically used as a
7448 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
7449 was verified :
7450
7451 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
7452 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
7453 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7454 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0 gt 5
7455 acl save sc1_clr_gpc0
7456 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
7457 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
7458
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007459sc1_conn_cnt
7460sc2_conn_cnt
7461 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
7462 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
7463
7464sc1_conn_cur
7465sc2_conn_cur
7466 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
7467 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
7468 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
7469
7470sc1_conn_rate
7471sc2_conn_rate
7472 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
7473 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
7474 See also src_conn_rate.
7475
7476sc1_get_gpc0
7477sc2_get_gpc0
7478 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
7479 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
7480
7481sc1_http_err_cnt
7482sc2_http_err_cnt
7483 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
7484 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
7485 See also src_http_err_cnt.
7486
7487sc1_http_err_rate
7488sc2_http_err_rate
7489 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
7490 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
7491 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
7492 src_http_err_rate.
7493
7494sc1_http_req_cnt
7495sc2_http_req_cnt
7496 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
7497 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
7498 src_http_req_cnt.
7499
7500sc1_http_req_rate
7501sc2_http_req_rate
7502 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
7503 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
7504 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
7505 src_http_req_rate.
7506
7507sc1_inc_gpc0
7508sc2_inc_gpc0
7509 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
7510 tracked counters, and returns its value. Before the first invocation, the
7511 stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
7512 return 1. The test can also be used alone and always returns true. This is
7513 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
7514 when a first ACL was verified :
7515
7516 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7517 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0
7518 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
7519
7520sc1_kbytes_in
7521sc2_kbytes_in
7522 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
7523 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
7524 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
7525 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
7526
7527sc1_kbytes_out
7528sc2_kbytes_out
7529 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
7530 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
7531 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
7532 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
7533
7534sc1_sess_cnt
7535sc2_sess_cnt
7536 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
7537 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
7538 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
7539 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
7540 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performend over the connection
7541 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
7542
7543sc1_sess_rate
7544sc2_sess_rate
7545 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
7546 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
7547 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
7548 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
7549 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
7550 performend over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
7551
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007552so_id <integer>
7553 Applies to the socket's id. Useful in frontends with many bind keywords.
7554
7555src <ip_address>
7556 Applies to the client's IPv4 address. It is usually used to limit access to
7557 certain resources such as statistics. Note that it is the TCP-level source
7558 address which is used, and not the address of a client behind a proxy.
7559
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007560src_bytes_in_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007561src_bytes_in_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007562 Returns the average bytes rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
7563 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7564 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007565 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007566
7567src_bytes_out_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007568src_bytes_out_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007569 Returns the average bytes rate to the connection's source IPv4 address in the
7570 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7571 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007572 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007573
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02007574src_clr_gpc0 <integer>
7575src_clr_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
7576 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
7577 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7578 stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not found, an
7579 entry is created and 0 is returned. The test can also be used alone and
7580 always returns true. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression
7581 in order to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
7582
7583 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
7584 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
7585 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
7586 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
7587 acl save src_clr_gpc0
7588 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
7589 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
7590
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007591src_conn_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007592src_conn_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007593 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
7594 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
7595 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007596 See also sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007597
7598src_conn_cur <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007599src_conn_cur(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007600 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
7601 current connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table
7602 or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007603 returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007604
7605src_conn_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007606src_conn_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007607 Returns the average connection rate from the connection's source IPv4 address
7608 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7609 in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007610 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007611
7612src_get_gpc0 <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007613src_get_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007614 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
7615 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
7616 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007617 See also sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007618
7619src_http_err_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007620src_http_err_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007621 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the current connection's
7622 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7623 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007624 If the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007625
7626src_http_err_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007627src_http_err_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007628 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the current connection's source
7629 IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
7630 table, measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table.
7631 This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007632 is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007633
7634src_http_req_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007635src_http_req_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007636 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the current connection's
7637 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7638 stick-table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007639 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007640
7641src_http_req_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007642src_http_req_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007643 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the current connection's
7644 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7645 stick-table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
7646 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007647 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007648
7649src_inc_gpc0 <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007650src_inc_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007651 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
7652 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7653 stick-table, and returns its value. If the address is not found, an entry is
7654 created and 1 is returned. The test can also be used alone and always returns
7655 true. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to
7656 mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
7657
7658 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
7659 acl kill src_inc_gpc0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007660 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007661
7662src_kbytes_in <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007663src_kbytes_in(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007664 Returns the amount of data received from the connection's source IPv4 address
7665 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7666 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
7667 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007668 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007669
7670src_kbytes_out <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007671src_kbytes_out(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007672 Returns the amount of data sent to the connection's source IPv4 address in
7673 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7674 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
7675 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007676 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007677
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007678src_port <integer>
7679 Applies to the client's TCP source port. This has a very limited usage.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007680
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007681src_sess_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007682src_sess_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007683 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
7684 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
7685 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
7686 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007687 is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007688
7689src_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007690src_sess_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007691 Returns the average session rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
7692 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7693 amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A session is a
7694 connection that got past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007695 found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007696
7697src_updt_conn_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007698src_updt_conn_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007699 Creates or updates the entry associated to the source IPv4 address in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007700 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table. This table
7701 must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise the match
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007702 will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the expiration
7703 timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match can't return
7704 zero. This is used to reject service abusers based on their source address.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007705 Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-counters" instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007706
7707 Example :
7708 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
7709 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
7710 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
7711 listen ssh
7712 bind :22
7713 mode tcp
7714 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007715 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007716 tcp-request content reject if { src_update_count gt 3 }
7717 server local 127.0.0.1:22
7718
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007719srv_conn(<backend>/<server>) <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +02007720 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the server,
7721 possibly including the connection being evaluated.
7722 It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is full.
7723 See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" criteria.
7724
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01007725srv_id <integer>
7726 Applies to the server's id. Can be used in frontends or backends.
7727
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +02007728srv_is_up(<server>)
7729srv_is_up(<backend>/<server>)
7730 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
7731 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
7732 looked up in the current backend. The function takes no arguments since it
7733 is used as a boolean. It is mainly used to take action based on an external
7734 status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's availability).
7735 Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in using dummy servers
7736 as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from the CLI, so that
7737 rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
7738
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02007739table_avl <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007740table_avl(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02007741 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
7742 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
7743
7744table_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007745table_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02007746 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
7747 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
7748 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
7749
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007750
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020077517.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4 (also called Layer 6)
7752---------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007753
7754A second set of criteria depends on data found in buffers, but which can change
7755during analysis. This requires that some data has been buffered, for instance
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007756through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request content"
7757keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007758
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01007759rep_ssl_hello_type <integer>
7760 Returns true when data in the response buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
7761 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
7762 This test was designed to be used with TCP response content inspection: a
7763 SSL session ID may be fetched.
7764
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007765req_len <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007766 Returns true when the length of the data in the request buffer matches the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007767 specified range. It is important to understand that this test does not
7768 return false as long as the buffer is changing. This means that a check with
7769 equality to zero will almost always immediately match at the beginning of the
7770 session, while a test for more data will wait for that data to come in and
7771 return false only when haproxy is certain that no more data will come in.
7772 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection.
7773
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02007774req_proto_http
7775 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
7776 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007777 is used so there should be no surprises. This test can be used for instance
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02007778 to direct HTTP traffic to a given port and HTTPS traffic to another one
7779 using TCP request content inspection rules.
7780
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007781req_rdp_cookie <string>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007782req_rdp_cookie(<name>) <string>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007783 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol, and
7784 a cookie is present and equal to <string>. By default, any cookie name is
7785 checked, but a specific cookie name can be specified in parenthesis. The
7786 parser only checks for the first cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol
7787 specification. The cookie name is case insensitive. This ACL can be useful
7788 with the "MSTS" cookie, as it can contain the user name of the client
7789 connecting to the server if properly configured on the client. This can be
7790 used to restrict access to certain servers to certain users.
7791
7792req_rdp_cookie_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007793req_rdp_cookie_cnt(<name>) <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007794 Returns true when the data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol
7795 and the number of RDP cookies matches the specified range (typically zero or
7796 one). Optionally a specific cookie name can be checked. This is a simple way
7797 of detecting the RDP protocol, as clients generally send the MSTS or MSTSHASH
7798 cookies.
7799
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01007800req_ssl_hello_type <integer>
7801 Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
7802 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
7803 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection: an
7804 SSL session ID may be fetched.
7805
7806req_ssl_sni <string>
7807 Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
7808 or superior) client hello message with a Server Name Indication TLS extension
7809 (SNI) matching <string>. SNI normally contains the name of the host the
7810 client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing
7811 or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This
7812 test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection. If content
7813 switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait for a complete client
7814 hello (type 1), like in the example below.
7815
7816 Examples :
7817 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
7818 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7819 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
7820 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
7821 default_backend bk_sorry_page
7822
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007823req_ssl_ver <decimal>
7824 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like SSL, with a protocol
7825 version matching the specified range. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
7826 messages are supported. The test tries to be strict enough to avoid being
7827 easily fooled. In particular, it waits for as many bytes as announced in the
7828 message header if this header looks valid (bound to the buffer size). Note
7829 that TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. This test was designed to be used
7830 with TCP request content inspection.
7831
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +02007832wait_end
7833 Waits for the end of the analysis period to return true. This may be used in
7834 conjunction with content analysis to avoid returning a wrong verdict early.
7835 It may also be used to delay some actions, such as a delayed reject for some
7836 special addresses. Since it either stops the rules evaluation or immediately
7837 returns true, it is recommended to use this acl as the last one in a rule.
7838 Please note that the default ACL "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior
7839 declaration. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
7840 inspection.
7841
7842 Examples :
7843 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
7844 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
7845 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
7846
7847 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
7848 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
7849 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
7850 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
7851 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
7852 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
7853 tcp-request content reject
7854
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007855
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020078567.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
7857--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007858
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007859A third set of criteria applies to information which can be found at the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007860application layer (layer 7). Those require that a full HTTP request has been
7861read, and are only evaluated then. They may require slightly more CPU resources
7862than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and response are indexed.
7863
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02007864cook(<name>) <string>
7865 All "cook*" matching criteria inspect all "Cookie" headers to find a cookie
7866 with the name between parenthesis. If multiple occurrences of the cookie are
7867 found in the request, they will all be evaluated. Spaces around the name and
7868 the value are ignored as requested by the Cookie specification (RFC6265). The
7869 cookie name is case-sensitive. Use the scook() variant for response cookies
7870 sent by the server.
7871
7872 The "cook" criteria returns true if any of the request cookies <name> match
7873 any of the strings. This can be used to check exact for values. For instance,
7874 checking that the "profile" cookie is set to either "silver" or "gold" :
7875
7876 cook(profile) silver gold
7877
7878cook_beg(<name>) <string>
7879 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> begins with one of the
7880 strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
7881 scook_beg() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
7882
7883cook_cnt(<name>) <integer>
7884 Returns true when the number of occurrences of the specified cookie matches
7885 the values or ranges specified. This is used to detect presence, absence or
7886 abuse of a specific cookie. See "cook" for more information on header
7887 matching. Use the scook_cnt() variant for response cookies sent by the
7888 server.
7889
7890cook_dir(<name>) <string>
7891 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains one of the strings
7892 either isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or
7893 directory name matching, though it generally is of limited use with cookies.
7894 See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the scook_dir()
7895 variant for response cookies sent by the server.
7896
7897cook_dom(<name>) <string>
7898 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains one of the strings
7899 either isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name
7900 matching. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
7901 scook_dom() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
7902
7903cook_end(<name>) <string>
7904 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> ends with one of the
7905 strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
7906 scook_end() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
7907
7908cook_len(<name>) <integer>
7909 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> has a length which matches
7910 the values or ranges specified. This may be used to detect empty or too large
7911 cookie values. Note that an absent cookie does not match a zero-length test.
7912 See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the scook_len()
7913 variant for response cookies sent by the server.
7914
7915cook_reg(<name>) <regex>
7916 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> matches any of the regular
7917 expressions. It can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that
7918 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also other "cook_" criteria,
7919 as well as "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
7920 scook_reg() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
7921
7922cook_sub(<name>) <string>
7923 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains at least one of
7924 the strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
7925 scook_sub() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
7926
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007927hdr <string>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007928hdr(<header>) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007929 Note: all the "hdr*" matching criteria either apply to all headers, or to a
7930 particular header whose name is passed between parenthesis and without any
7931 space. The header name is not case-sensitive. The header matching complies
7932 with RFC2616, and treats as separate headers all values delimited by commas.
7933 Use the shdr() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7934
7935 The "hdr" criteria returns true if any of the headers matching the criteria
7936 match any of the strings. This can be used to check exact for values. For
7937 instance, checking that "connection: close" is set :
7938
7939 hdr(Connection) -i close
7940
7941hdr_beg <string>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007942hdr_beg(<header>) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007943 Returns true when one of the headers begins with one of the strings. See
7944 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_beg() variant for
7945 response headers sent by the server.
7946
7947hdr_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007948hdr_cnt(<header>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007949 Returns true when the number of occurrence of the specified header matches
7950 the values or ranges specified. It is important to remember that one header
7951 line may count as several headers if it has several values. This is used to
7952 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
7953 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
7954 of certain headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use
7955 the shdr_cnt() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7956
7957hdr_dir <string>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007958hdr_dir(<header>) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007959 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
7960 isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or
7961 directory name matching, and may be used with Referer. See "hdr" for more
7962 information on header matching. Use the shdr_dir() variant for response
7963 headers sent by the server.
7964
7965hdr_dom <string>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007966hdr_dom(<header>) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007967 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
7968 isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name matching,
7969 and may be used with the Host header. See "hdr" for more information on
7970 header matching. Use the shdr_dom() variant for response headers sent by the
7971 server.
7972
7973hdr_end <string>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007974hdr_end(<header>) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007975 Returns true when one of the headers ends with one of the strings. See "hdr"
7976 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_end() variant for
7977 response headers sent by the server.
7978
7979hdr_ip <ip_address>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007980hdr_ip(<header>) <ip_address>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007981 Returns true when one of the headers' values contains an IP address matching
7982 <ip_address>. This is mainly used with headers such as X-Forwarded-For or
7983 X-Client-IP. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
7984 shdr_ip() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7985
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02007986hdr_len <integer>
7987hdr_len(<header>) <integer>
7988 Returns true when at least one of the headers has a length which matches the
7989 values or ranges specified. This may be used to detect empty or too large
7990 headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
7991 shdr_len() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7992
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007993hdr_reg <regex>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007994hdr_reg(<header>) <regex>
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02007995 Returns true it one of the headers matches one of the regular expressions. It
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007996 can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching
7997 is slower than other methods. See also other "hdr_" criteria, as well as
7998 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_reg() variant for
7999 response headers sent by the server.
8000
8001hdr_sub <string>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008002hdr_sub(<header>) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008003 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings. See "hdr"
8004 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_sub() variant for
8005 response headers sent by the server.
8006
8007hdr_val <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008008hdr_val(<header>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008009 Returns true when one of the headers starts with a number which matches the
8010 values or ranges specified. This may be used to limit content-length to
8011 acceptable values for example. See "hdr" for more information on header
8012 matching. Use the shdr_val() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8013
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008014http_auth(<userlist>)
8015http_auth_group(<userlist>) <group> [<group>]*
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008016 Returns true when authentication data received from the client matches
8017 username & password stored on the userlist. It is also possible to
8018 use http_auth_group to check if the user is assigned to at least one
8019 of specified groups.
8020
8021 Currently only http basic auth is supported.
8022
Willy Tarreau85c27da2011-09-16 07:53:52 +02008023http_first_req
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +02008024 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
8025 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
8026 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or even to perform
8027 some specific ACL checks only on the first request.
8028
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008029method <string>
8030 Applies to the method in the HTTP request, eg: "GET". Some predefined ACL
8031 already check for most common methods.
8032
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008033path <string>
8034 Returns true when the path part of the request, which starts at the first
8035 slash and ends before the question mark, equals one of the strings. It may be
8036 used to match known files, such as /favicon.ico.
8037
8038path_beg <string>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008039 Returns true when the path begins with one of the strings. This can be used
8040 to send certain directory names to alternative backends.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008041
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008042path_dir <string>
8043 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
8044 slashes in the path. This is used to perform filename or directory name
8045 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
8046 "url_dir" and "path_sub".
8047
8048path_dom <string>
8049 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8050 in the path. This may be used to perform domain name matching in proxy
8051 requests. See also "path_sub" and "url_dom".
8052
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008053path_end <string>
8054 Returns true when the path ends with one of the strings. This may be used to
8055 control file name extension.
8056
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008057path_len <integer>
8058 Returns true when the path length matches the values or ranges specified.
8059 This may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8060
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008061path_reg <regex>
8062 Returns true when the path matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
8063 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
8064 than other methods. See also "url_reg" and all "path_" criteria.
8065
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008066path_sub <string>
8067 Returns true when the path contains one of the strings. It can be used to
8068 detect particular patterns in paths, such as "../" for example. See also
8069 "path_dir".
8070
8071req_ver <string>
8072 Applies to the version string in the HTTP request, eg: "1.0". Some predefined
8073 ACL already check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
8074
8075status <integer>
8076 Applies to the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, eg: "302". It can be
8077 used to act on responses depending on status ranges, for instance, remove
8078 any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
8079
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008080url <string>
8081 Applies to the whole URL passed in the request. The only real use is to match
8082 "*", for which there already is a predefined ACL.
8083
8084url_beg <string>
8085 Returns true when the URL begins with one of the strings. This can be used to
8086 check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a protocol scheme.
8087
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008088url_dir <string>
8089 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
8090 slashes in the URL. This is used to perform filename or directory name
8091 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
8092 "path_dir" and "url_sub".
8093
8094url_dom <string>
8095 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8096 in the URL. This is used to perform domain name matching without the risk of
8097 wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "url_sub".
8098
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008099url_end <string>
8100 Returns true when the URL ends with one of the strings. It has very limited
8101 use. "path_end" should be used instead for filename matching.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008102
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01008103url_ip <ip_address>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008104 Applies to the IP address specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP request.
8105 It can be used to prevent access to certain resources such as local network.
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008106 It is useful with option "http_proxy".
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01008107
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008108url_len <integer>
8109 Returns true when the url length matches the values or ranges specified. This
8110 may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8111
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01008112url_port <integer>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008113 Applies to the port specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP request. It can
8114 be used to prevent access to certain resources. It is useful with option
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008115 "http_proxy". Note that if the port is not specified in the request, port 80
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008116 is assumed.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01008117
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008118url_reg <regex>
8119 Returns true when the URL matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
8120 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
8121 than other methods. See also "path_reg" and all "url_" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01008122
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008123url_sub <string>
8124 Returns true when the URL contains one of the strings. It can be used to
8125 detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See also "path_sub".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01008126
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008127
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020081287.6. Pre-defined ACLs
8129---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008130
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008131Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
8132every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02008133order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008134
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008135ACL name Equivalent to Usage
8136---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008137FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02008138HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008139HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
8140HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008141HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
8142HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
8143HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
8144HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
8145LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008146METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
8147METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
8148METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
8149METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
8150METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
8151METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008152RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008153REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008154TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008155WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
8156---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008157
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008158
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020081597.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
8160----------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008161
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008162Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
8163combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008164
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008165 - AND (implicit)
8166 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
8167 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008168
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008169A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008170
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008171 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008172
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008173Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
8174indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008175
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008176For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
8177"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
8178requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
8179is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008180
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008181 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
8182 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
8183 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
8184 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008185
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008186To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
8187and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008188
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008189 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
8190 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
8191 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
8192 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008193
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008194 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
8195 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
8196 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
8197 use_backend www if host_www
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008198
Willy Tarreau95fa4692010-02-01 13:05:50 +01008199It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
8200expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
8201be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
8202the braces must be seen as independant words). Example :
8203
8204 The following rule :
8205
8206 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
8207 block if METH_POST missing_cl
8208
8209 Can also be written that way :
8210
8211 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
8212
8213It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
8214to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
8215simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
8216sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
8217good use is the following :
8218
8219 With named ACLs :
8220
8221 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
8222 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
8223 monitor fail if site_dead
8224
8225 With anonymous ACLs :
8226
8227 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
8228
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008229See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008230
Willy Tarreau5764b382007-11-30 17:46:49 +01008231
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010082327.8. Pattern extraction
8233-----------------------
8234
8235The stickiness features relies on pattern extraction in the request and
8236response. Sometimes the data needs to be converted first before being stored,
8237for instance converted from ASCII to IP or upper case to lower case.
8238
8239All these operations of data extraction and conversion are defined as
8240"pattern extraction rules". A pattern rule always has the same format. It
8241begins with a single pattern fetch word, potentially followed by a list of
8242arguments within parenthesis then an optional list of transformations. As
8243much as possible, the pattern fetch functions use the same name as their
8244equivalent used in ACLs.
8245
8246The list of currently supported pattern fetch functions is the following :
8247
8248 src This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session.
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008249 It is of type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
8250 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent,
8251 according to RFC 4291.
8252
8253 src6 This is the source IPv6 address of the client of the session.
8254 It is of type IPv6 and only works with such tables.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008255
8256 dst This is the destination IPv4 address of the session on the
8257 client side, which is the address the client connected to.
8258 It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008259 type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
8260 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent,
8261 according to RFC 4291.
8262
8263 dst6 This is the destination IPv6 address of the session on the
8264 client side, which is the address the client connected to.
8265 It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09008266 type IPv6 and only works with such tables.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008267
8268 dst_port This is the destination TCP port of the session on the client
8269 side, which is the port the client connected to. This might be
8270 used when running in transparent mode or when assigning dynamic
8271 ports to some clients for a whole application session. It is of
8272 type integer and only works with such tables.
8273
Willy Tarreaue428fb72011-12-16 21:50:30 +01008274 hdr(<name>) This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP
8275 request. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once
8276 converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreau4a568972010-05-12 08:08:50 +02008277
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008278 payload(<offset>,<length>)
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008279 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes, and starting
8280 at bytes <offset> in the buffer of request or response (request
8281 on "stick on" or "stick match" or response in on "stick store
8282 response").
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008283
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008284 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>])
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008285 This extracts a binary block. In a first step the size of the
8286 block is read from response or request buffer at <offset>
8287 bytes and considered coded on <length> bytes. In a second step
8288 data of the block are read from buffer at <offset2> bytes
8289 (by default <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize>).
8290 If <offset2> is prefixed by '+' or '-', it is relative to
8291 <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize> else it is absolute.
8292 Ex: see SSL session id example in "stick table" chapter.
8293
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008294 url_param(<name>)
David Cournapeau16023ee2010-12-23 20:55:41 +09008295 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09008296 the query string of the request and uses the corresponding value
David Cournapeau16023ee2010-12-23 20:55:41 +09008297 to match. A typical use is to get sticky session through url (e.g.
8298 http://example.com/foo?JESSIONID=some_id with
8299 url_param(JSESSIONID)), for cases where cookies cannot be used.
8300
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008301 rdp_cookie(<name>)
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008302 This extracts the value of the rdp cookie <name> as a string
8303 and uses this value to match. This enables implementation of
8304 persistence based on the mstshash cookie. This is typically
8305 done if there is no msts cookie present.
8306
8307 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing
8308 algorithm may be used and thus the distribution of clients
8309 to backend servers is not linked to a hash of the RDP
8310 cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
8311 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconnect" will
8312 lead to a more even distribution of clients to backend
8313 servers than the hash used by "balance rdp-cookie".
8314
8315 Example :
8316 listen tse-farm
8317 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
8318 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
8319 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8320 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
8321 # apply RDP cookie persistence
8322 persist rdp-cookie
8323 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
8324 # This is only useful makes sense if
8325 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
8326 stick-table type string size 204800
8327 stick on rdp_cookie(mstshash)
8328 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
8329 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
8330
8331 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie",
8332 "tcp-request" and the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
8333
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008334 cookie(<name>)
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02008335 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a
8336 "Cookie" header line from the request and uses the corresponding
8337 value to match. A typical use is to get multiple clients sharing
8338 a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
8339 "appsession" does with the "request-learn" statement, but with
8340 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across
8341 restarts.
8342
8343 See also : "appsession"
8344
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008345 set-cookie(<name>)
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02008346 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a
8347 "Set-Cookie" header line from the response and uses the
8348 corresponding value to match. This can be comparable to what
8349 "appsession" does with default options, but with support for
8350 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
8351
8352 See also : "appsession"
8353
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008354
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008355The currently available list of transformations include :
8356
8357 lower Convert a string pattern to lower case. This can only be placed
8358 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
8359 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
8360
8361 upper Convert a string pattern to upper case. This can only be placed
8362 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
8363 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
8364
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008365 ipmask(<mask>) Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups
Willy Tarreaud31d6eb2010-01-26 18:01:41 +01008366 and storage. This can be used to make all hosts within a
8367 certain mask to share the same table entries and as such use
8368 the same server. The mask can be passed in dotted form (eg:
8369 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
8370
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008371
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020083728. Logging
8373----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008374
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008375One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
8376provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
8377very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
8378provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
8379state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008380to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008381headers.
8382
8383In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
8384about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
8385send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
8386
8387 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
8388 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
8389 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
8390 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
8391 at the termination.
8392
8393The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
8394allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
8395as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
8396while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
8397real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
8398delay.
8399
8400
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020084018.1. Log levels
8402---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008403
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09008404TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008405source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09008406HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
8407in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
8408track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
8409syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
8410about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008411
8412
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020084138.2. Log formats
8414----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008415
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008416HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09008417and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
8418slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
8419options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008420
8421 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
8422 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
8423 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
8424 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
8425 extents.
8426
8427 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
8428 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
8429 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
8430 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
8431 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
8432
8433 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
8434 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
8435 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
8436 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
8437 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
8438
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008439 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
8440 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
8441 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
8442 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
8443
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008444 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
8445
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008446Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
8447specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
8448field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
8449servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
8450always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
8451identifier.
8452
8453Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
8454 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
8455 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
8456 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
8457 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
8458
8459
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020084608.2.1. Default log format
8461-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008462
8463This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
8464as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
8465format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
8466
8467 Example :
8468 listen www
8469 mode http
8470 log global
8471 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
8472
8473 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
8474 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
8475 (www/HTTP)
8476
8477 Field Format Extract from the example above
8478 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
8479 2 'Connect from' Connect from
8480 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
8481 4 'to' to
8482 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
8483 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
8484
8485Detailed fields description :
8486 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
8487 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
8488 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
8489 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
8490 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
8491 and processed the connection.
8492 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
8493
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008494In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
8495"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
8496connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
8497
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008498It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
8499will eventually disappear.
8500
8501
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085028.2.2. TCP log format
8503---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008504
8505The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
8506is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
8507information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
8508counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
8509emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
8510environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
8511the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
8512sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008513specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
8514not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
8515fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
8516marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008517
8518 Example :
8519 frontend fnt
8520 mode tcp
8521 option tcplog
8522 log global
8523 default_backend bck
8524
8525 backend bck
8526 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
8527
8528 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
8529 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
8530 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
8531
8532 Field Format Extract from the example above
8533 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
8534 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
8535 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
8536 4 frontend_name fnt
8537 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
8538 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
8539 7 bytes_read* 212
8540 8 termination_state --
8541 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
8542 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
8543
8544Detailed fields description :
8545 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008546 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
8547 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
8548 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
8549 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
8550 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008551
8552 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008553 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
8554 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
8555 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008556
8557 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
8558 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
8559 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
8560 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
8561
8562 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
8563 and processed the connection.
8564
8565 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
8566 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
8567 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
8568 applications.
8569
8570 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
8571 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
8572 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
8573 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
8574 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
8575
8576 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
8577 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
8578 See "Timers" below for more details.
8579
8580 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
8581 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
8582 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
8583 "Timers" below for more details.
8584
8585 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
8586 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
8587 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
8588 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
8589 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
8590 details.
8591
8592 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
8593 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
8594 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
8595 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
8596 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
8597
8598 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
8599 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
8600 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
8601 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
8602 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
8603 for more details.
8604
8605 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
8606 the session was logged. It it useful to detect when some per-process system
8607 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
8608 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
8609 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008610 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008611
8612 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
8613 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
8614 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
8615 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
8616 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
8617 caused by a denial of service attack.
8618
8619 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
8620 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
8621 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
8622 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
8623 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
8624 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
8625 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
8626 denial of service attack.
8627
8628 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
8629 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
8630 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
8631 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
8632 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
8633 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
8634 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
8635 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
8636 be processed than on other servers.
8637
8638 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
8639 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
8640 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
8641 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
8642 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
8643 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
8644 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
8645 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
8646 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
8647 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
8648 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
8649 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
8650 should not be attributed to the logged server.
8651
8652 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
8653 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
8654 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
8655 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
8656 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
8657 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
8658 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
8659 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
8660
8661 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
8662 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
8663 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
8664 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
8665 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
8666 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
8667 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
8668 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
8669 occurs.
8670
8671
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020086728.2.3. HTTP log format
8673----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008674
8675The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
8676is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
8677the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
8678are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
8679emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
8680generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
8681"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
8682which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008683frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
8684is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008685
8686Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
8687slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
8688with a star ('*') after the field name below.
8689
8690 Example :
8691 frontend http-in
8692 mode http
8693 option httplog
8694 log global
8695 default_backend bck
8696
8697 backend static
8698 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
8699
8700 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
8701 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
8702 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008703 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008704
8705 Field Format Extract from the example above
8706 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
8707 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
8708 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
8709 4 frontend_name http-in
8710 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
8711 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
8712 7 status_code 200
8713 8 bytes_read* 2750
8714 9 captured_request_cookie -
8715 10 captured_response_cookie -
8716 11 termination_state ----
8717 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
8718 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
8719 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
8720 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
8721 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008722
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008723
8724Detailed fields description :
8725 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008726 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
8727 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
8728 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
8729 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
8730 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008731
8732 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008733 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
8734 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
8735 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008736
8737 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
8738 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
8739 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
8740 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
8741 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
8742
8743 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
8744 and processed the connection.
8745
8746 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
8747 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
8748 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
8749
8750 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
8751 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
8752 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
8753 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
8754 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
8755 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
8756
8757 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
8758 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
8759 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
8760 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
8761 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
8762 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
8763
8764 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
8765 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
8766 See "Timers" below for more details.
8767
8768 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
8769 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
8770 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
8771 below for more details.
8772
8773 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
8774 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
8775 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
8776 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
8777 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
8778 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
8779 for more details.
8780
8781 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
8782 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
8783 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
8784 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
8785 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
8786 details.
8787
8788 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
8789 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
8790 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
8791
8792 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
8793 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
8794 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
8795 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
8796 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
8797 overflowing.
8798
8799 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
8800 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
8801 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
8802 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
8803 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
8804 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
8805 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
8806 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
8807
8808 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
8809 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
8810 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
8811 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
8812 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
8813 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
8814 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
8815 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
8816
8817 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
8818 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
8819 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
8820 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
8821 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
8822 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
8823 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
8824
8825 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
8826 the session was logged. It it useful to detect when some per-process system
8827 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
8828 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
8829 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008830 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008831 system.
8832
8833 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
8834 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
8835 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
8836 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
8837 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
8838 caused by a denial of service attack.
8839
8840 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
8841 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
8842 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
8843 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
8844 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
8845 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
8846 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
8847 denial of service attack.
8848
8849 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
8850 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
8851 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
8852 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
8853 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
8854 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
8855 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
8856 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
8857 processed than on other servers.
8858
8859 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
8860 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
8861 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
8862 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
8863 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
8864 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
8865 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
8866 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
8867 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
8868 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
8869 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
8870 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
8871 should not be attributed to the logged server.
8872
8873 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
8874 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
8875 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
8876 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
8877 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
8878 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
8879 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
8880 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
8881
8882 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
8883 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
8884 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
8885 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
8886 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
8887 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
8888 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
8889 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
8890 occurs.
8891
8892 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
8893 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
8894 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
8895 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
8896 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
8897 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
8898 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
8899 cookies" below for more details.
8900
8901 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
8902 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
8903 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
8904 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
8905 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
8906 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
8907 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
8908 and cookies" below for more details.
8909
8910 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
8911 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
8912 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
8913 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
8914 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
8915 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
8916 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
8917 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
8918
8919
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010089208.2.4 Custom log format
8921-----------------------
8922
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01008923The directive log-format allows you to custom the logs in http mode and tcp
8924mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008925
8926HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
8927Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
8928separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
8929prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
8930
8931Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
8932variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
8933string formats ("Q").
8934
8935Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
8936HAproxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
8937
8938Flags are :
8939 * Q: quote a string
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02008940 * X: hexadecimal represenation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008941
8942 Example:
8943
8944 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
8945 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
8946
8947At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
8948
8949 log-format %Ci:%Cp\ [%t]\ %f\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %st\ %B\ %cc\ \
Willy Tarreau6580c062012-03-12 15:09:42 +01008950 %cs\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008951
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01008952the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008953
8954 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}Ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %st\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %Cp\ \
Willy Tarreau6580c062012-03-12 15:09:42 +01008955 %ms\ %f\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008956 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %cc\ %cs\ \%hrl\ %hsl
8957
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01008958and the default TCP format is defined this way :
8959
8960 log-format %Ci:%Cp\ [%t]\ %f\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
8961 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
8962
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008963Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
8964
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01008965 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
8966 | H | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
8967 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
8968 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
8969 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
8970 | | %B | bytes_read | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02008971 | | %Ci | client_ip | IP |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01008972 | | %Cp | client_port | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02008973 | | %Bi | backend_source_ip | IP |
William Lallemandb7ff6a32012-03-02 14:35:21 +01008974 | | %Bp | backend_source_port | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02008975 | | %Fi | frontend_ip | IP |
8976 | | %Fp | frontend_port | numeric |
8977 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008978 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02008979 | | %Si | server_IP | IP |
8980 | | %Sp | server_port | numeric |
8981 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01008982 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
8983 | * | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
8984 | * | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02008985 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01008986 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
8987 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
8988 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
8989 | | %b | backend_name | string |
8990 | | %bc | beconn | numeric |
8991 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
8992 | * | %cc | captured_request_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02008993 | * | %rt | http_request_counter | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01008994 | * | %cs | captured_response_cookie | string |
8995 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
8996 | | %fc | feconn | numeric |
8997 | * | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
8998 | * | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
8999 | * | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
9000 | * | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
9001 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009002 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009003 | * | %r | http_request | string |
9004 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
9005 | | %s | server_name | string |
9006 | | %sc | srv_conn | numeric |
9007 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
9008 | * | %st | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009009 | | %t | date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009010 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreau6580c062012-03-12 15:09:42 +01009011 | * | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009012 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009013
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009014*: mode http only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020090168.3. Advanced logging options
9017-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009018
9019Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
9020just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
9021options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
9022for more information about their usage.
9023
9024
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020090258.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
9026------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009027
9028It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
9029haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
9030commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
9031monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
9032ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
9033
9034 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
9035 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
9036 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
9037 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
9038
9039 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
9040 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
9041 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
9042 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipments
9043 such as other load-balancers.
9044
9045 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
9046 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
9047 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
9048
9049
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020090508.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
9051----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009052
9053The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
9054what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
9055or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
9056"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
9057just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
9058log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
9059after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
9060is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
9061with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
9062with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
9063
9064
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020090658.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
9066------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009067
9068Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
9069for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
9070"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
9071retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
9072raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
9073a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
9074file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
9075you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
9076"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
9077
9078
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020090798.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
9080--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009081
9082Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
9083multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
9084them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
9085"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
9086logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
9087error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
9088and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
9089too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
9090useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
9091alternative.
9092
9093
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020090948.4. Timing events
9095------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009096
9097Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
9098reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
9099the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
9100frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
9101mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
9102
9103 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
9104 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
9105 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
9106 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
9107 the client closes prematurely or times out.
9108
9109 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
9110 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
9111 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
9112 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
9113 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
9114
9115 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
9116 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
9117 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
9118 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
9119 connection never established.
9120
9121 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
9122 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
9123 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
9124 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
9125 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
9126 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
9127 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
9128 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
9129 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
9130 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
9131 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
9132
9133 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
9134 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
9135 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
9136 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
9137 transmission time, by substracting other timers when valid :
9138
9139 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
9140
9141 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
9142 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
9143 negative.
9144
9145These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
9146protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
9147that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009148due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009149close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
9150session has been aborted on timeout.
9151
9152Most common cases :
9153
9154 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
9155 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
9156 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
9157 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
9158 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
9159 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
9160 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
9161 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
9162 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +02009163 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
9164 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
9165 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009166
9167 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
9168 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
9169 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
9170 of ms on remote networks.
9171
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009172 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
9173 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
9174 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009175
9176 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
9177 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
9178 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
9179 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
9180 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
9181 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
9182 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
9183 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
9184 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
9185 to the server until another one is released.
9186
9187Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
9188
9189 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
9190 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
9191 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
9192
9193 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
9194 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
9195 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
9196
9197 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
9198 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
9199 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
9200 flags.
9201
9202 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
9203 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
9204 Check the session termination flags, then check the
9205 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
9206 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
9207 the client connection was maintained open.
9208
9209 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
9210 a complete response in time, or it closed its connexion
9211 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
9212 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
9213
9214
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020092158.5. Session state at disconnection
9216-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009217
9218TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
9219"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
92202-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
9221each of which has a special meaning :
9222
9223 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
9224 session to terminate :
9225
9226 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
9227
9228 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
9229 server explicitly refused it.
9230
9231 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
9232 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
9233 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
9234 error in server response which might have caused information leak
9235 (eg: cacheable cookie), or because the response was processed by
9236 the proxy (redirect, stats, etc...).
9237
9238 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
9239 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
9240 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
9241 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
9242 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
9243
9244 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
9245 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
9246 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
9247 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
9248 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
9249
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +09009250 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
9251 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
9252
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +02009253 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
9254
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009255 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
9256 send or receive data.
9257
9258 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
9259 send or receive data.
9260
9261 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
9262 with nothing left in the buffers.
9263
9264 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
9265
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01009266 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009267 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
9268
9269 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
9270 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
9271 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
9272 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
9273 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
9274
9275 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
9276 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
9277
9278 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
9279 server (HTTP only).
9280
9281 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
9282
9283 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
9284 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
9285 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
9286
9287 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
9288 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
9289 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
9290
9291 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
9292
9293 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
9294 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
9295
9296 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
9297 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
9298 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
9299
9300 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
9301 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02009302 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
9303 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009304
9305 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
9306 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
9307 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
9308 another server.
9309
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009310 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009311 server.
9312
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009313 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
9314 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
9315 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
9316 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
9317
9318 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
9319 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
9320 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
9321 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
9322
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +02009323 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
9324 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
9325 "use-server" rule).
9326
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009327 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
9328
9329 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
9330 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
9331
9332 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
9333
9334 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
9335 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
9336 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
9337
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009338 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
9339 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
9340 happens everytime there is activity at a different date than the
9341 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
9342 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
9343
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009344 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
9345
9346 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
9347 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
9348
9349 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
9350
9351 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
9352
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009353The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
9354was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009355helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
9356starvation, attacks, etc...
9357
9358The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
9359alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
9360easier finding and understanding.
9361
9362 Flags Reason
9363
9364 -- Normal termination.
9365
9366 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
9367 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
9368 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
9369 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
9370
9371 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
9372 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
9373 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
9374 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
9375 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
9376 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009377
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009378 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
9379 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
9380 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
9381
9382 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
9383 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
9384 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
9385
9386 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
9387 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
9388 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
9389 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
9390 the server takes too long to respond.
9391
9392 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
9393 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
9394 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
9395 long a time to respond.
9396
9397 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
9398 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
9399 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
9400 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
9401 and the client.
9402
9403 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
9404 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
9405 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
9406 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
9407 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
9408 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here.
9409
9410 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
9411 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009412 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
9413 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
9414 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
9415 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009416
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009417 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009418 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
9419 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
9420 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
9421 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
9422 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
9423
9424 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
9425 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
9426 503 or 504 here.
9427
9428 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
9429 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
9430 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
9431 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
9432 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
9433
9434 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
9435 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009436 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009437 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
9438 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
9439
9440 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
9441 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
9442 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
9443 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
9444 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
9445 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
9446 between haproxy and the server.
9447
9448 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
9449 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
9450 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
9451 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
9452 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
9453 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
9454 solution is to fix the application.
9455
9456 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
9457 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
9458 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
9459 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
9460 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
9461 external attacks.
9462
9463 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
9464 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
9465 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
9466 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
9467 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
9468
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +01009469 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
9470 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
9471 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
9472 the client.
9473
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009474 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
9475 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
9476 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
9477 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +01009478 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
9479 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
9480 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
9481 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
9482 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009483
9484 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
9485 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
9486 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
9487 returned an HTTP 403 error.
9488
9489 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
9490 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
9491 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
9492 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
9493
9494 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
9495 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
9496 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
9497 only be solved by proper system tuning.
9498
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009499The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
9500persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
9501important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
9502re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
9503
9504 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
9505
9506 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
9507 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
9508 set on a GET request.
9509
9510 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
9511 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
9512 a "server" entry is removed from the configuraton, since its cookie
9513 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
9514
9515 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
9516 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
9517 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
9518
9519 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
9520 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
9521 already got a cookie.
9522
9523 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
9524 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
9525 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
9526 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
9527 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
9528
9529 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
9530 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
9531 new cookie was inserted in the response.
9532
9533 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
9534 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
9535 new cookie was inserted in the response.
9536
9537 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
9538 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
9539
9540 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
9541 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
9542 then advertised in the response.
9543
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009544
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095458.6. Non-printable characters
9546-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009547
9548In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
9549consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
9550converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
9551prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
9552being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
9553escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
9554is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
9555'}' when logging headers.
9556
9557Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
9558issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
9559containing spaces is "User-Agent".
9560
9561Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
9562the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
9563performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
9564
9565
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095668.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
9567---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009568
9569Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
9570achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009571section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009572cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
9573the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
9574the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009575locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009576not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
9577user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
9578a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
9579wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
9580
9581 Examples :
9582 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
9583 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
9584
9585 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
9586 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
9587
9588
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095898.8. Capturing HTTP headers
9590---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009591
9592Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
9593proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
9594the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
9595server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
9596
9597Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
9598response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009599section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009600
9601It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009602time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
9603appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009604are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
9605and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
9606follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
9607request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
9608in the logs.
9609
9610 Example :
9611 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
9612 listen proxy-out
9613 mode http
9614 option httplog
9615 option logasap
9616 log global
9617 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
9618
9619 # log the name of the virtual server
9620 capture request header Host len 20
9621
9622 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
9623 capture request header Content-Length len 10
9624
9625 # log the beginning of the referrer
9626 capture request header Referer len 20
9627
9628 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
9629 capture response header Server len 20
9630
9631 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
9632 capture response header Content-Length len 10
9633
9634 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
9635 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
9636
9637 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
9638 capture response header Via len 20
9639
9640 # log the URL location during a redirection
9641 capture response header Location len 20
9642
9643 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
9644 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
9645 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
9646 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
9647 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
9648
9649 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
9650 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
9651 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
9652 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009653 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009654
9655 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
9656 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
9657 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
9658 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
9659 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009660 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009661
9662
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020096638.9. Examples of logs
9664---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009665
9666These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
9667them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
9668reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
9669
9670 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
9671 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
9672 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
9673
9674 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
9675 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
9676
9677 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
9678 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
9679 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
9680
9681 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
9682 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
9683
9684 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
9685 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
9686 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
9687
9688 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009689 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009690 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
9691 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
9692
9693 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
9694 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
9695 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
9696
9697 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
9698 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02009699 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009700 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
9701 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
9702 to return the 502 and not the server.
9703
9704 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009705 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009706
9707 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
9708 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
9709 Nothing was sent to any server.
9710
9711 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
9712 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
9713
9714 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
9715 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
9716 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
9717 send a 408 return code to the client.
9718
9719 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
9720 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
9721
9722 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
9723 5 seconds ("c----").
9724
9725 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
9726 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009727 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009728
9729 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009730 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009731 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
9732 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
9733 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
9734 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
9735 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009736
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009737
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020097389. Statistics and monitoring
9739----------------------------
9740
9741It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
9742mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
9743CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
9744Unix socket.
9745
9746
97479.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009748---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009749
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +01009750The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
9751page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow.
9752
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009753 0. pxname: proxy name
9754 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
9755 for server)
9756 2. qcur: current queued requests
9757 3. qmax: max queued requests
9758 4. scur: current sessions
9759 5. smax: max sessions
9760 6. slim: sessions limit
9761 7. stot: total sessions
9762 8. bin: bytes in
9763 9. bout: bytes out
9764 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01009765 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009766 12. ereq: request errors
9767 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +01009768 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009769 15. wretr: retries (warning)
9770 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +01009771 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009772 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
9773 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
9774 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
9775 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
9776 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
9777 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
9778 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
9779 25. qlimit: queue limit
9780 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
9781 27. iid: unique proxy id
9782 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
9783 29. throttle: warm up status
9784 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
9785 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02009786 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +02009787 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
9788 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
9789 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +02009790 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01009791 UNK -> unknown
9792 INI -> initializing
9793 SOCKERR -> socket error
9794 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
9795 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
9796 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
9797 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
9798 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
9799 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
9800 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
9801 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
9802 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
9803 disable-on-404
9804 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
9805 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
9806 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +02009807 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
9808 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009809 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
9810 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
9811 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
9812 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
9813 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
9814 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009815 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
9816 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
9817 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
9818 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +01009819 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
9820 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009821
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009822
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020098239.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009824-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01009825
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009826The following commands are supported on the UNIX stats socket ; all of them
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009827must be terminated by a line feed. The socket supports pipelining, so that it
9828is possible to chain multiple commands at once provided they are delimited by
9829a semi-colon or a line feed, although the former is more reliable as it has no
9830risk of being truncated over the network. The responses themselves will each be
9831followed by an empty line, so it will be easy for an external script to match a
9832given response with a given request. By default one command line is processed
9833then the connection closes, but there is an interactive allowing multiple lines
9834to be issued one at a time.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009835
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009836It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
9837on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
9838own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009839
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009840clear counters
9841 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
9842 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
9843 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
9844 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
9845 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
9846
9847clear counters all
9848 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
9849 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
9850 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
9851
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +09009852clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
9853 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
9854
9855 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
9856 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
9857 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
9858 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
9859 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
9860 later after the session ends is usual enough.
9861
9862 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
9863
9864 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
9865 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
9866 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
9867 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
9868 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
9869 the ACLs :
9870
9871 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
9872 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
9873 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
9874 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
9875 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
9876 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
9877
9878 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +09009879 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
9880 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009881
9882 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009883 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009884 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009885 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
9886 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
9887 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9888 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009889
9890 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9891
9892 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009893 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02009894 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
9895 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +09009896 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9897 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
9898 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02009899
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +02009900disable frontend <frontend>
9901 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
9902 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
9903 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
9904 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
9905 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
9906 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
9907 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
9908 on the stats page.
9909
9910 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
9911 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
9912
9913 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
9914 level "admin".
9915
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009916disable server <backend>/<server>
9917 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
9918 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
9919 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
9920 during the maintenance.
9921
9922 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
9923 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
9924
9925 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +02009926 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009927
9928 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
9929 level "admin".
9930
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +02009931enable frontend <frontend>
9932 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
9933 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
9934 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
9935 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
9936 which was disabled.
9937
9938 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
9939 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
9940
9941 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
9942 level "admin".
9943
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009944enable server <backend>/<server>
9945 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
9946 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
9947
9948 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +02009949 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009950
9951 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
9952 level "admin".
9953
9954get weight <backend>/<server>
9955 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
9956 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
9957 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
9958 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
9959 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +02009960 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009961
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009962help
9963 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
9964 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009965
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009966prompt
9967 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
9968 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
9969 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
9970 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
9971 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
9972 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
9973 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
9974 command.
9975
9976quit
9977 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01009978
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +02009979set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
9980 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any non-null
9981 positive value is allowed, but setting values larger than the global maxconn
9982 does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections were
9983 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
9984 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
9985 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
9986 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
9987
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +02009988set maxconn global <maxconn>
9989 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
9990 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
9991 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
9992 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
9993 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
9994 setting.
9995
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +02009996set rate-limit connections global <value>
9997 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
9998 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
9999 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
10000 is passed in number of connections per second.
10001
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010002set timeout cli <delay>
10003 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
10004 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
10005 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
10006
10007set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
10008 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
10009 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
10010 configured weight. Relative weights are only permitted between 0 and 100%,
10011 and absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256. Servers which are part
10012 of a farm running a static load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations
10013 because the weight cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only
10014 accepted values are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take
10015 effect immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
10016 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to disable
10017 a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to enable it
10018 again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command is restricted
10019 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin". Both the
10020 backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by their
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020010021 numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010022
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010010023show errors [<iid>]
10024 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
10025 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020010026 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
10027 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
10028 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010010029
10030 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
10031 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
10032 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
10033 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
10034 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
10035 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
10036 are reported too.
10037
10038 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
10039 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
10040 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
10041 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
10042 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
10043 code.
10044
10045 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
10046 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
10047 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
10048 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
10049 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
10050 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
10051 line.
10052
10053 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010054 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
10055 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010010056 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
10057 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
10058
10059 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
10060 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
10061 00038 Location: blah\r\n
10062 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
10063 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
10064 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
10065 00204+ minal\r\n
10066 00211 \r\n
10067
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010068 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010010069 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
10070 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
10071 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
10072 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
10073 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
10074 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010010075
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010076show info
10077 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
10078
10079show sess
10080 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020010081 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
10082 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
10083
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010010084show sess <id>
10085 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
10086 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
10087 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
10088 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
10089 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
10090 freely evolve depending on demands.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010091
10092show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
10093 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
10094 possible to dump only selected items :
10095 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
10096 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
10097 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
10098 for example:
10099 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
10100 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
10101 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
10102
10103 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010104 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
10105 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010106 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
10107 Release_date: 2009/09/23
10108 Nbproc: 1
10109 Process_num: 1
10110 (...)
10111
10112 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
10113 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
10114 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
10115 (...)
10116 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
10117
10118 $
10119
10120 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
10121 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
10122 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
10123 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010124 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010125
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010126show table
10127 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
10128 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
10129 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
10130 entries currently in use.
10131
10132 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010133 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090010134 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
10135 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010136
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090010137show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010138 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
10139 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
10140 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090010141 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
10142
10143 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
10144 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
10145 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
10146 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
10147 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
10148
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010149 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
10150 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
10151 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
10152 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
10153 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
10154 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
10155
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090010156
10157 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090010158 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
10159 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090010160
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010161 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010162 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090010163 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010164 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
10165 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
10166 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10167 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010168
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010169 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090010170 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010171 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10172 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010173
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010174 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
10175 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090010176 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010177 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10178 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010179
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090010180 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
10181 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090010182 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090010183 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10184 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
10185
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010186 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
10187 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
10188 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
10189 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
10190 time goes, the average event rate drops.
10191
10192 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
10193 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
10194 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010195 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
10196 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010197 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
10198 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020010199
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020010200shutdown frontend <frontend>
10201 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
10202 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
10203 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
10204 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
10205 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
10206 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
10207 once it is terminated.
10208
10209 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
10210 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
10211
10212 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
10213 level "admin".
10214
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020010215shutdown session <id>
10216 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
10217 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
10218 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
10219 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
10220 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
10221 flag in the logs.
10222
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020010223shutdown sessions <backend>/<server>
10224 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
10225 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
10226 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
10227 'K' flag in the logs.
10228
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010229/*
10230 * Local variables:
10231 * fill-column: 79
10232 * End:
10233 */